1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 22 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 23 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h" 24 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 28 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 29 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 30 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 31 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 32 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 33 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 34 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 36 #include <algorithm> 37 #include <cstdlib> 38 39 using namespace clang; 40 using namespace sema; 41 42 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 43 return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 44 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 45 }); 46 } 47 48 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function. 49 static ExprResult 50 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 51 bool HadMultipleCandidates, 52 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 53 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 54 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc)) 55 return ExprError(); 56 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template 57 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 58 // called on both. 59 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 60 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 61 // being used. 62 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc)) 63 return ExprError(); 64 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 65 S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 66 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(), 67 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 68 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 69 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 70 71 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 72 return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()), 73 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay); 74 } 75 76 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 77 bool InOverloadResolution, 78 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 79 bool CStyle, 80 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 81 82 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 83 QualType &ToType, 84 bool InOverloadResolution, 85 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 86 bool CStyle); 87 static OverloadingResult 88 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 89 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 90 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 91 bool AllowExplicit, 92 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 93 94 95 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 96 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 97 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 98 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 99 100 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 101 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 102 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 104 105 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 106 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 107 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 108 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 109 110 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 111 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 112 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 113 static const ImplicitConversionRank 114 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 115 ICR_Exact_Match, 116 ICR_Exact_Match, 117 ICR_Exact_Match, 118 ICR_Exact_Match, 119 ICR_Exact_Match, 120 ICR_Exact_Match, 121 ICR_Promotion, 122 ICR_Promotion, 123 ICR_Promotion, 124 ICR_Conversion, 125 ICR_Conversion, 126 ICR_Conversion, 127 ICR_Conversion, 128 ICR_Conversion, 129 ICR_Conversion, 130 ICR_Conversion, 131 ICR_Conversion, 132 ICR_Conversion, 133 ICR_Conversion, 134 ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening, 135 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 136 ICR_Conversion, 137 ICR_Conversion, 138 ICR_Writeback_Conversion, 139 ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right -- 140 // it was omitted by the patch that added 141 // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion 142 ICR_C_Conversion, 143 ICR_C_Conversion_Extension 144 }; 145 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 146 } 147 148 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 149 /// implicit conversion. 150 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 151 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 152 "No conversion", 153 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 154 "Array-to-pointer", 155 "Function-to-pointer", 156 "Function pointer conversion", 157 "Qualification", 158 "Integral promotion", 159 "Floating point promotion", 160 "Complex promotion", 161 "Integral conversion", 162 "Floating conversion", 163 "Complex conversion", 164 "Floating-integral conversion", 165 "Pointer conversion", 166 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 167 "Boolean conversion", 168 "Compatible-types conversion", 169 "Derived-to-base conversion", 170 "Vector conversion", 171 "Vector splat", 172 "Complex-real conversion", 173 "Block Pointer conversion", 174 "Transparent Union Conversion", 175 "Writeback conversion", 176 "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion", 177 "C specific type conversion", 178 "Incompatible pointer conversion" 179 }; 180 return Name[Kind]; 181 } 182 183 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 184 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 185 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 186 First = ICK_Identity; 187 Second = ICK_Identity; 188 Third = ICK_Identity; 189 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 190 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 191 ReferenceBinding = false; 192 DirectBinding = false; 193 IsLvalueReference = true; 194 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 195 BindsToRvalue = false; 196 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 197 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 198 CopyConstructor = nullptr; 199 } 200 201 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 202 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 203 /// implicit conversions. 204 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 205 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 206 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 207 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 208 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 209 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 210 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 211 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 212 return Rank; 213 } 214 215 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 216 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 217 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 218 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 219 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 220 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 221 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 222 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 223 // a pointer. 224 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 225 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 226 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 227 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 228 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() || 229 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 230 return true; 231 232 return false; 233 } 234 235 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 236 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 237 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 238 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 239 bool 240 StandardConversionSequence:: 241 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 242 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 243 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 244 245 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 246 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 247 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 248 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 249 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 250 251 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 252 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 253 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 254 255 return false; 256 } 257 258 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 259 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 260 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) { 261 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 262 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 263 case CK_NoOp: 264 case CK_IntegralCast: 265 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 266 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 267 case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral: 268 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 269 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 270 case CK_FloatingCast: 271 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 272 continue; 273 274 default: 275 return Converted; 276 } 277 } 278 279 return Converted; 280 } 281 282 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 283 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 284 /// 285 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 286 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 287 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 288 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 289 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 290 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 291 NarrowingKind 292 StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx, 293 const Expr *Converted, 294 APValue &ConstantValue, 295 QualType &ConstantType) const { 296 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 297 298 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 299 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 300 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 301 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 302 303 // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to 304 // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of 305 // the form 'Enum{init}'. 306 if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>()) 307 ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 308 309 switch (Second) { 310 // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it. 311 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 312 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType()) 313 goto FloatingIntegralConversion; 314 if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 315 goto IntegralConversion; 316 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members 317 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions. 318 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 319 320 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 321 // 322 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 323 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 324 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 325 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 326 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 327 FloatingIntegralConversion: 328 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 329 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 330 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 331 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue; 332 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 333 assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression"); 334 335 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 336 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 337 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 338 339 if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) { 340 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 341 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 342 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(), 343 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 344 // And back. 345 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue; 346 bool ignored; 347 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 348 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 349 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 350 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 351 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue); 352 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 353 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 354 } 355 } else { 356 // Variables are always narrowings. 357 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 358 } 359 } 360 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 361 362 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 363 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 364 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 365 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 366 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 367 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 368 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 369 // FromType is larger than ToType. 370 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 371 372 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 373 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 374 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 375 376 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 377 // Constant! 378 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 379 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 380 // Convert the source value into the target type. 381 bool ignored; 382 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 383 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 384 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 385 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 386 // values that can be represented. 387 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 388 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 389 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 390 } 391 } else { 392 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 393 } 394 } 395 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 396 397 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 398 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 399 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 400 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 401 // value when converted back to the original type. 402 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 403 IntegralConversion: { 404 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 405 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 406 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 407 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 408 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 409 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 410 411 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 412 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) || 413 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) { 414 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 415 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue; 416 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 417 418 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 419 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 420 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 421 422 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) { 423 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing. 424 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 425 } 426 bool Narrowing = false; 427 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) { 428 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never 429 // narrowing. 430 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative()) 431 Narrowing = true; 432 } else { 433 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 434 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 435 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 436 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 437 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 438 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 439 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 440 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 441 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 442 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 443 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 444 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 445 Narrowing = true; 446 } 447 if (Narrowing) { 448 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 449 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 450 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 451 } 452 } 453 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 454 } 455 456 default: 457 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 458 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 459 } 460 } 461 462 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 463 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 464 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const { 465 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 466 bool PrintedSomething = false; 467 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 468 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 469 PrintedSomething = true; 470 } 471 472 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 473 if (PrintedSomething) { 474 OS << " -> "; 475 } 476 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 477 478 if (CopyConstructor) { 479 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 480 } else if (DirectBinding) { 481 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 482 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 483 OS << " (reference binding)"; 484 } 485 PrintedSomething = true; 486 } 487 488 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 489 if (PrintedSomething) { 490 OS << " -> "; 491 } 492 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 493 PrintedSomething = true; 494 } 495 496 if (!PrintedSomething) { 497 OS << "No conversions required"; 498 } 499 } 500 501 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 502 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 503 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const { 504 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 505 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 506 Before.dump(); 507 OS << " -> "; 508 } 509 if (ConversionFunction) 510 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 511 else 512 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 513 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 514 OS << " -> "; 515 After.dump(); 516 } 517 } 518 519 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 520 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 521 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const { 522 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 523 if (isStdInitializerListElement()) 524 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: "; 525 switch (ConversionKind) { 526 case StandardConversion: 527 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 528 Standard.dump(); 529 break; 530 case UserDefinedConversion: 531 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 532 UserDefined.dump(); 533 break; 534 case EllipsisConversion: 535 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 536 break; 537 case AmbiguousConversion: 538 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 539 break; 540 case BadConversion: 541 OS << "Bad conversion"; 542 break; 543 } 544 545 OS << "\n"; 546 } 547 548 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 549 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 550 } 551 552 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 553 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 554 } 555 556 void 557 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 558 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 559 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 560 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 561 } 562 563 namespace { 564 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 565 // template argument information. 566 struct DFIArguments { 567 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 568 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 569 }; 570 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 571 // template parameter and template argument information. 572 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments { 573 TemplateParameter Param; 574 }; 575 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument 576 // information and the index of the problematic call argument. 577 struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments { 578 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 579 unsigned CallArgIndex; 580 }; 581 } 582 583 /// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 584 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 585 DeductionFailureInfo 586 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 587 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 588 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 589 DeductionFailureInfo Result; 590 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 591 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 592 switch (TDK) { 593 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 594 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 595 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 596 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 597 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 598 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 599 Result.Data = nullptr; 600 break; 601 602 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 603 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 604 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 605 break; 606 607 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 608 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 609 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 610 auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs; 611 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 612 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 613 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 614 Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex; 615 Result.Data = Saved; 616 break; 617 } 618 619 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 620 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 621 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments; 622 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 623 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 624 Result.Data = Saved; 625 break; 626 } 627 628 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 629 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 630 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 631 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 632 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 633 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 634 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 635 Result.Data = Saved; 636 break; 637 } 638 639 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 640 Result.Data = Info.take(); 641 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 642 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 643 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 644 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 645 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 646 } 647 break; 648 649 case Sema::TDK_Success: 650 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 651 llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure"); 652 } 653 654 return Result; 655 } 656 657 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 658 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 659 case Sema::TDK_Success: 660 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 661 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 662 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 663 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 664 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 665 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 666 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 667 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 668 break; 669 670 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 671 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 672 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 673 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 674 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 675 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 676 Data = nullptr; 677 break; 678 679 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 680 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 681 Data = nullptr; 682 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 683 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 684 HasDiagnostic = false; 685 } 686 break; 687 688 // Unhandled 689 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 690 break; 691 } 692 } 693 694 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 695 if (HasDiagnostic) 696 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 697 return nullptr; 698 } 699 700 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 701 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 702 case Sema::TDK_Success: 703 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 704 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 705 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 706 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 707 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 708 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 709 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 710 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 711 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 712 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 713 return TemplateParameter(); 714 715 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 716 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 717 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 718 719 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 720 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 721 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 722 723 // Unhandled 724 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 725 break; 726 } 727 728 return TemplateParameter(); 729 } 730 731 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 732 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 733 case Sema::TDK_Success: 734 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 735 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 736 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 737 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 738 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 739 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 740 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 741 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 742 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 743 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 744 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 745 return nullptr; 746 747 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 748 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 749 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 750 751 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 752 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 753 754 // Unhandled 755 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 756 break; 757 } 758 759 return nullptr; 760 } 761 762 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 763 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 764 case Sema::TDK_Success: 765 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 766 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 767 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 768 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 769 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 770 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 771 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 772 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 773 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 774 return nullptr; 775 776 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 777 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 778 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 779 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 780 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 781 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 782 783 // Unhandled 784 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 785 break; 786 } 787 788 return nullptr; 789 } 790 791 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 792 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 793 case Sema::TDK_Success: 794 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 795 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 796 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 797 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 798 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 799 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 800 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 801 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 802 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 803 return nullptr; 804 805 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 806 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 807 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 808 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 809 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 810 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 811 812 // Unhandled 813 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 814 break; 815 } 816 817 return nullptr; 818 } 819 820 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() { 821 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 822 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 823 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 824 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex; 825 826 default: 827 return llvm::None; 828 } 829 } 830 831 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 832 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 833 for (auto &C : i->Conversions) 834 C.~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 835 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 836 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 837 } 838 } 839 840 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() { 841 destroyCandidates(); 842 SlabAllocator.Reset(); 843 NumInlineBytesUsed = 0; 844 Candidates.clear(); 845 Functions.clear(); 846 } 847 848 namespace { 849 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 850 struct Entry { 851 Expr **Addr; 852 Expr *Saved; 853 }; 854 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 855 856 public: 857 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 858 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 859 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 860 Entries.push_back(entry); 861 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 862 } 863 864 void restore() { 865 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 866 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 867 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 868 } 869 }; 870 } 871 872 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 873 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 874 /// 875 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 876 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 877 /// 878 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 879 static bool 880 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 881 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) { 882 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 883 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 884 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 885 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 886 887 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 888 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 889 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 890 unbridgedCasts) { 891 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 892 return false; 893 } 894 895 // Go ahead and check everything else. 896 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 897 if (result.isInvalid()) 898 return true; 899 900 E = result.get(); 901 return false; 902 } 903 904 // Nothing to do. 905 return false; 906 } 907 908 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 909 /// placeholders. 910 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, 911 MultiExprArg Args, 912 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 913 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 914 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged)) 915 return true; 916 917 return false; 918 } 919 920 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the 921 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if 922 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as 923 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't 924 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or 925 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be 926 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying 927 /// declaration. 928 /// 929 /// Example: Given the following input: 930 /// 931 /// void f(int, float); // #1 932 /// void f(int, int); // #2 933 /// int f(int, int); // #3 934 /// 935 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload 936 /// will not be used. 937 /// 938 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing 939 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have 940 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is 941 /// unchanged. 942 /// 943 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare 944 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then 945 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of 946 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and 947 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 948 /// 949 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class 950 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations 951 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's 952 /// signature. 953 Sema::OverloadKind 954 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 955 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 956 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 957 I != E; ++I) { 958 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 959 960 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 961 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 962 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 963 964 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 965 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 966 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 967 968 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 969 } 970 971 // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration 972 // if one of them is hidden. 973 if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I)) 974 continue; 975 976 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 977 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 978 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 979 // function templates hide function templates with different 980 // return types or template parameter lists. 981 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 982 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() && 983 !New->getFriendObjectKind(); 984 985 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) { 986 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 987 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 988 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 989 continue; 990 } 991 992 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) && 993 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New)) 994 continue; 995 996 Match = *I; 997 return Ovl_Match; 998 } 999 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) { 1000 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 1001 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 1002 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 1003 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 1004 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 1005 } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 1006 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 1007 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 1008 // template instantiation. 1009 // 1010 // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class 1011 // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator. 1012 if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) { 1013 Match = *I; 1014 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1015 } 1016 } else { 1017 // (C++ 13p1): 1018 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 1019 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 1020 Match = *I; 1021 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1022 } 1023 } 1024 1025 return Ovl_Overload; 1026 } 1027 1028 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 1029 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1030 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded. 1031 if (New->isMain()) 1032 return false; 1033 1034 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded. 1035 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 1036 return false; 1037 1038 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1039 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1040 1041 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 1042 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 1043 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 1044 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr)) 1045 return true; 1046 1047 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 1048 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 1049 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 1050 1051 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 1052 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 1053 // in the signature, they are overloads. 1054 1055 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 1056 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 1057 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 1058 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 1059 return false; 1060 1061 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 1062 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 1063 1064 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 1065 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 1066 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 1067 if (OldQType != NewQType && 1068 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() || 1069 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 1070 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 1071 return true; 1072 1073 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 1074 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 1075 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 1076 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 1077 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 1078 // signature. 1079 // 1080 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 1081 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 1082 // 1083 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 1084 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 1085 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 1086 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1087 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1088 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 1089 OldType->getReturnType() != NewType->getReturnType())) 1090 return true; 1091 1092 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 1093 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 1094 // 1095 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 1096 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 1097 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 1098 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 1099 // can be overloaded. 1100 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 1101 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 1102 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 1103 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) { 1104 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) { 1105 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && 1106 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 1107 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 1108 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 1109 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 1110 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 1111 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 1112 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 1113 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 1114 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 1115 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 1116 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1117 } 1118 return true; 1119 } 1120 1121 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member 1122 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static 1123 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this 1124 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod. 1125 unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers(); 1126 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers(); 1127 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() && 1128 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 1129 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const; 1130 1131 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'. 1132 OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict; 1133 NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict; 1134 if (OldQuals != NewQuals) 1135 return true; 1136 } 1137 1138 // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we 1139 // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function 1140 // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with 1141 // pass_object_size or it doesn't. 1142 if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) != 1143 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old)) 1144 return true; 1145 1146 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature. 1147 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> 1148 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1149 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(), 1150 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1151 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(); 1152 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) { 1153 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE) 1154 return true; 1155 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1156 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true); 1157 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true); 1158 if (NewID != OldID) 1159 return true; 1160 } 1161 1162 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1163 // Don't allow overloading of destructors. (In theory we could, but it 1164 // would be a giant change to clang.) 1165 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) 1166 return false; 1167 1168 CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New), 1169 OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old); 1170 if (NewTarget == CFT_InvalidTarget) 1171 return false; 1172 1173 assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && "Unexpected invalid target."); 1174 1175 // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA 1176 // target attributes. 1177 return NewTarget != OldTarget; 1178 } 1179 1180 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 1181 return false; 1182 } 1183 1184 /// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current 1185 /// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored. 1186 /// 1187 /// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside 1188 /// an available function, false otherwise. 1189 bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) { 1190 if (!FD->isUnavailable()) 1191 return false; 1192 1193 // Walk up the context of the caller. 1194 Decl *C = cast<Decl>(CurContext); 1195 do { 1196 if (C->isUnavailable()) 1197 return false; 1198 } while ((C = cast_or_null<Decl>(C->getDeclContext()))); 1199 return true; 1200 } 1201 1202 /// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 1203 /// 1204 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 1205 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 1206 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1207 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1208 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1209 bool AllowExplicit, 1210 bool InOverloadResolution, 1211 bool CStyle, 1212 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1213 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1214 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1215 1216 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1217 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1218 // we can perform. 1219 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1220 return ICS; 1221 } 1222 1223 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1224 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(), 1225 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1226 switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 1227 Conversions, AllowExplicit, 1228 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) { 1229 case OR_Success: 1230 case OR_Deleted: 1231 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1232 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1233 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1234 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1235 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1236 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1237 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1238 // called for those cases. 1239 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1240 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1241 QualType FromCanon 1242 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1243 QualType ToCanon 1244 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1245 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1246 (FromCanon == ToCanon || 1247 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1248 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1249 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1250 DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction; 1251 ICS.setStandard(); 1252 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1253 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1254 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1255 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1256 ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found; 1257 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1258 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1259 } 1260 } 1261 break; 1262 1263 case OR_Ambiguous: 1264 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1265 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1266 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1267 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1268 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1269 if (Cand->Viable) 1270 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 1271 break; 1272 1273 // Fall through. 1274 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 1275 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1276 break; 1277 } 1278 1279 return ICS; 1280 } 1281 1282 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1283 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1284 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1285 /// to perform the initialization. Given 1286 /// 1287 /// void f(float f); 1288 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1289 /// 1290 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1291 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1292 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1293 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1294 // 1295 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1296 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1297 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1298 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1299 /// "BadConversion". 1300 /// 1301 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1302 /// not permitted. 1303 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1304 /// permitted. 1305 /// 1306 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1307 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1308 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1309 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1310 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1311 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1312 bool AllowExplicit, 1313 bool InOverloadResolution, 1314 bool CStyle, 1315 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1316 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1317 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1318 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1319 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1320 ICS.setStandard(); 1321 return ICS; 1322 } 1323 1324 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1325 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1326 return ICS; 1327 } 1328 1329 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1330 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1331 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1332 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1333 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1334 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1335 // called for those cases. 1336 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1337 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1338 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1339 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromType, ToType))) { 1340 ICS.setStandard(); 1341 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1342 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1343 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1344 1345 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1346 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1347 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1348 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1349 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1350 1351 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1352 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1353 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1354 1355 return ICS; 1356 } 1357 1358 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1359 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1360 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1361 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 1362 } 1363 1364 ImplicitConversionSequence 1365 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1366 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1367 bool AllowExplicit, 1368 bool InOverloadResolution, 1369 bool CStyle, 1370 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1371 return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1372 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit, 1373 InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1374 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1375 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1376 } 1377 1378 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1379 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1380 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1381 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1382 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1383 ExprResult 1384 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1385 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) { 1386 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1387 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS); 1388 } 1389 1390 ExprResult 1391 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1392 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit, 1393 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) { 1394 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1395 return ExprError(); 1396 1397 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1398 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1399 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1400 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1401 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) 1402 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getLocStart(), 1403 ToType, From->getType(), From); 1404 ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1405 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1406 AllowExplicit, 1407 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1408 /*CStyle=*/false, 1409 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1410 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1411 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1412 } 1413 1414 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1415 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function 1416 /// type. 1417 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1418 QualType &ResultTy) { 1419 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1420 return false; 1421 1422 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1423 // or F(t noexcept) -> F(t) 1424 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1425 // - a pointer 1426 // - a member pointer 1427 // - a block pointer 1428 // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType. 1429 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1430 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1431 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1432 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1433 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1434 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1435 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1436 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1437 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1438 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1439 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1440 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1441 auto ToMPT = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1442 auto FromMPT = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1443 // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function. 1444 if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass()) 1445 return false; 1446 CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType(); 1447 CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType(); 1448 } else { 1449 return false; 1450 } 1451 1452 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1453 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1454 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1455 return false; 1456 } 1457 1458 const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1459 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1460 1461 const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo); 1462 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo(); 1463 1464 bool Changed = false; 1465 1466 // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type. 1467 if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) { 1468 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1469 Changed = true; 1470 } 1471 1472 // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type. 1473 if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) { 1474 const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn); 1475 if (FromFPT->isNothrow(Context) && !ToFPT->isNothrow(Context)) { 1476 FromFn = cast<FunctionType>( 1477 Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(), 1478 FromFPT->getParamTypes(), 1479 FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec( 1480 FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo())) 1481 .getTypePtr()); 1482 Changed = true; 1483 } 1484 } 1485 1486 if (!Changed) 1487 return false; 1488 1489 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1490 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1491 1492 ResultTy = ToType; 1493 return true; 1494 } 1495 1496 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1497 /// vector conversion. 1498 /// 1499 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1500 /// conversion. 1501 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 1502 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1503 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1504 // conversion. 1505 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1506 return false; 1507 1508 // Identical types require no conversions. 1509 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1510 return false; 1511 1512 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1513 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1514 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1515 // identity conversion. 1516 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1517 return false; 1518 1519 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1520 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1521 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1522 return true; 1523 } 1524 } 1525 1526 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1527 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1528 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1529 // same size 1530 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1531 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1532 S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) { 1533 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1534 return true; 1535 } 1536 } 1537 1538 return false; 1539 } 1540 1541 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1542 bool InOverloadResolution, 1543 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1544 bool CStyle); 1545 1546 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1547 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1548 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1549 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1550 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1551 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1552 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1553 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1554 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1555 bool InOverloadResolution, 1556 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1557 bool CStyle, 1558 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1559 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1560 1561 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1562 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1563 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1564 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1565 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1566 1567 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1568 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them. 1569 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1570 (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType())) 1571 return false; 1572 1573 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1574 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1575 // (C++ 4p1). 1576 1577 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1578 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1579 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1580 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1581 AccessPair)) { 1582 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1583 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1584 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1585 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1586 1587 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1588 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1589 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1590 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1591 QualType resultTy; 1592 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1593 if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, 1594 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1595 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1596 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1597 return false; 1598 } 1599 1600 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1601 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1602 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1603 // expression. 1604 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1605 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1606 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1607 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1608 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1609 == UO_AddrOf && 1610 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1611 const Type *ClassType 1612 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1613 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1614 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1615 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1616 UO_AddrOf && 1617 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1618 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1619 } 1620 1621 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1622 // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't 1623 // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block. 1624 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1625 FromType, 1626 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1627 } else { 1628 return false; 1629 } 1630 } 1631 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1632 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1633 // be converted to a prvalue. 1634 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1635 if (argIsLValue && 1636 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1637 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1638 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1639 1640 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 1641 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 1642 // of the type of the lvalue ... 1643 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1644 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 1645 1646 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1647 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1648 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1649 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1650 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1651 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1652 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1653 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1654 1655 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1656 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1657 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1658 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1659 1660 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1661 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4) 1662 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1663 1664 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1665 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1666 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1667 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1668 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1669 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1670 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1671 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1672 return true; 1673 } 1674 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1675 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1676 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1677 1678 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts())) 1679 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 1680 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 1681 return false; 1682 1683 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1684 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1685 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1686 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1687 } else { 1688 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1689 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1690 } 1691 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1692 1693 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1694 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1695 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1696 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1697 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1698 // conversion. 1699 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1700 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1701 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1702 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1703 // conversion to do. 1704 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1705 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1706 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1707 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1708 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1709 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1710 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1711 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1712 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1713 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1714 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1715 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1716 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1717 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1718 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1719 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1720 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1721 FromType->isMemberPointerType() || 1722 FromType->isNullPtrType())) { 1723 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1724 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1725 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1726 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1727 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1728 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1729 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1730 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1731 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) { 1732 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1733 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1734 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1735 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1736 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1737 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1738 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1739 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1740 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1741 // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if 1742 // their representation is different until there is back end support 1743 // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double. 1744 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) != 1745 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) { 1746 bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1747 ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) || 1748 (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1749 ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty)); 1750 if (Float128AndLongDouble && 1751 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) != 1752 &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble())) 1753 return false; 1754 } 1755 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1756 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1757 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1758 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1759 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1760 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1761 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1762 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1763 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1764 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1765 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1766 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1767 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1768 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1769 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1770 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1771 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1772 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1773 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1774 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1775 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1776 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1777 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1778 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1779 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1780 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1781 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1782 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1783 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1784 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1785 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1786 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1787 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1788 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1789 InOverloadResolution, 1790 SCS, CStyle)) { 1791 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1792 FromType = ToType; 1793 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1794 CStyle)) { 1795 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 1796 // appropriately. 1797 return true; 1798 } else if (ToType->isEventT() && 1799 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1800 From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) { 1801 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion; 1802 FromType = ToType; 1803 } else if (ToType->isQueueT() && 1804 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1805 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) { 1806 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion; 1807 FromType = ToType; 1808 } else { 1809 // No second conversion required. 1810 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1811 } 1812 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1813 1814 // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a 1815 // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]). 1816 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1817 if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1818 // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of 1819 // 'noreturn' (Clang extension). 1820 SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion; 1821 } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1822 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1823 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1824 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1825 FromType = ToType; 1826 } else { 1827 // No conversion required 1828 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1829 } 1830 1831 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1832 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1833 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1834 // a conversion. [...] 1835 QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1836 QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1837 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1838 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1839 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) { 1840 FromType = ToType; 1841 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1842 } 1843 1844 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1845 1846 if (CanonFrom == CanonTo) 1847 return true; 1848 1849 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1850 // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C. 1851 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution) 1852 return false; 1853 1854 ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From}; 1855 Sema::AssignConvertType Conv = 1856 S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER, 1857 /*Diagnose=*/false, 1858 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, 1859 /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 1860 ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv; 1861 switch (Conv) { 1862 case Sema::Compatible: 1863 SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion; 1864 break; 1865 // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an 1866 // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop 1867 // qualifiers, as well. 1868 case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 1869 case Sema::IncompatiblePointer: 1870 case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign: 1871 SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 1872 break; 1873 default: 1874 return false; 1875 } 1876 1877 // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the 1878 // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the 1879 // function. 1880 SCS.Second = SecondConv; 1881 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 1882 1883 // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other 1884 // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just 1885 // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything 1886 // from making this ICK_Qualification. 1887 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1888 SCS.setToType(2, ToType); 1889 return true; 1890 } 1891 1892 static bool 1893 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 1894 QualType &ToType, 1895 bool InOverloadResolution, 1896 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1897 bool CStyle) { 1898 1899 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 1900 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 1901 return false; 1902 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 1903 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 1904 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 1905 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) { 1906 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1907 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 1908 ToType = it->getType(); 1909 return true; 1910 } 1911 } 1912 return false; 1913 } 1914 1915 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 1916 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 1917 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 1918 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 1919 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1920 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1921 // All integers are built-in. 1922 if (!To) { 1923 return false; 1924 } 1925 1926 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 1927 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 1928 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 1929 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 1930 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 1931 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 1932 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 1933 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 1934 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 1935 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 1936 // less than int to an int. 1937 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) { 1938 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 1939 } 1940 1941 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 1942 } 1943 1944 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3: 1945 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 1946 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 1947 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 1948 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 1949 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 1950 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 1951 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 1952 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 1953 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 1954 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 1955 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 1956 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4: 1957 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed 1958 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if 1959 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an 1960 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be 1961 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type. 1962 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 1963 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 1964 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 1965 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 1966 return false; 1967 1968 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum, 1969 // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting 1970 // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider 1971 // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression. 1972 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) { 1973 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 1974 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) || 1975 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType); 1976 } 1977 1978 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 1979 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 1980 isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType)) 1981 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1982 ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 1983 } 1984 1985 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 1986 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 1987 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 1988 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 1989 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 1990 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 1991 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 1992 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 1993 // type. 1994 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 1995 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 1996 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 1997 // unsigned. 1998 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 1999 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 2000 2001 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 2002 // order. Try each of these types. 2003 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 2004 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 2005 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 2006 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 2007 }; 2008 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 2009 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2010 if (FromSize < ToSize || 2011 (FromSize == ToSize && 2012 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 2013 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 2014 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 2015 // promotion. 2016 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2017 } 2018 } 2019 } 2020 2021 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 2022 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 2023 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 2024 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 2025 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 2026 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 2027 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 2028 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 2029 // conversion. 2030 if (From) { 2031 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) { 2032 llvm::APSInt BitWidth; 2033 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 2034 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) { 2035 llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned()); 2036 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 2037 2038 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 2039 if (BitWidth < ToSize || 2040 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 2041 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2042 } 2043 2044 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 2045 // that fits into an unsigned int? 2046 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) { 2047 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2048 } 2049 2050 return false; 2051 } 2052 } 2053 } 2054 2055 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 2056 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 2057 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 2058 return true; 2059 } 2060 2061 return false; 2062 } 2063 2064 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 2065 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 2066 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2067 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2068 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 2069 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2070 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 2071 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 2072 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 2073 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 2074 return true; 2075 2076 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 2077 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 2078 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 2079 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2080 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 2081 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 2082 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble || 2083 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128)) 2084 return true; 2085 2086 // Half can be promoted to float. 2087 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 2088 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 2089 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 2090 return true; 2091 } 2092 2093 return false; 2094 } 2095 2096 /// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 2097 /// 2098 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 2099 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 2100 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 2101 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2102 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2103 if (!FromComplex) 2104 return false; 2105 2106 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2107 if (!ToComplex) 2108 return false; 2109 2110 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 2111 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 2112 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(), 2113 ToComplex->getElementType()); 2114 } 2115 2116 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 2117 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 2118 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 2119 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 2120 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 2121 /// 2122 static QualType 2123 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 2124 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 2125 ASTContext &Context, 2126 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 2127 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 2128 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 2129 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 2130 2131 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 2132 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 2133 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2134 2135 QualType CanonFromPointee 2136 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 2137 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 2138 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2139 2140 if (StripObjCLifetime) 2141 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2142 2143 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 2144 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 2145 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 2146 if (!ToType.isNull()) 2147 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2148 2149 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 2150 // already. 2151 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2152 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 2153 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 2154 } 2155 2156 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 2157 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 2158 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 2159 2160 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2161 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2162 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2163 } 2164 2165 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 2166 bool InOverloadResolution, 2167 ASTContext &Context) { 2168 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 2169 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 2170 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 2171 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 2172 return !InOverloadResolution; 2173 2174 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2175 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2176 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 2177 } 2178 2179 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2180 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 2181 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 2182 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 2183 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 2184 /// ConvertedType. 2185 /// 2186 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 2187 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 2188 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 2189 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 2190 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 2191 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 2192 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 2193 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 2194 /// should result in a warning. 2195 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2196 bool InOverloadResolution, 2197 QualType& ConvertedType, 2198 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2199 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2200 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 2201 IncompatibleObjC)) 2202 return true; 2203 2204 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 2205 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2206 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2207 ConvertedType = ToType; 2208 return true; 2209 } 2210 2211 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 2212 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 2213 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 2214 ConvertedType = ToType; 2215 return true; 2216 } 2217 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 2218 // pointer type. 2219 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 2220 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2221 ConvertedType = ToType; 2222 return true; 2223 } 2224 2225 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 2226 // pointer constant. 2227 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 2228 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2229 ConvertedType = ToType; 2230 return true; 2231 } 2232 2233 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2234 if (!ToTypePtr) 2235 return false; 2236 2237 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 2238 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2239 ConvertedType = ToType; 2240 return true; 2241 } 2242 2243 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 2244 // , including objective-c pointers. 2245 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2246 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 2247 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2248 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 2249 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 2250 ToPointeeType, 2251 ToType, Context); 2252 return true; 2253 } 2254 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2255 if (!FromTypePtr) 2256 return false; 2257 2258 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2259 2260 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 2261 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 2262 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2263 return false; 2264 2265 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 2266 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 2267 // 4.10p2). 2268 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 2269 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2270 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2271 ToPointeeType, 2272 ToType, Context, 2273 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 2274 return true; 2275 } 2276 2277 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 2278 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 2279 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2280 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2281 ToPointeeType, 2282 ToType, Context); 2283 return true; 2284 } 2285 2286 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 2287 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 2288 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2289 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2290 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2291 ToPointeeType, 2292 ToType, Context); 2293 return true; 2294 } 2295 2296 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 2297 // 2298 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 2299 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 2300 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 2301 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 2302 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 2303 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 2304 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 2305 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 2306 // 2307 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 2308 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 2309 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2310 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2311 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 2312 IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2313 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2314 ToPointeeType, 2315 ToType, Context); 2316 return true; 2317 } 2318 2319 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 2320 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2321 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2322 ToPointeeType, 2323 ToType, Context); 2324 return true; 2325 } 2326 2327 return false; 2328 } 2329 2330 /// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 2331 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 2332 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 2333 2334 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 2335 if (TQs == Qs) 2336 return T; 2337 2338 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 2339 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 2340 2341 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 2342 } 2343 2344 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2345 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2346 /// with the same arguments and return values. 2347 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2348 QualType& ConvertedType, 2349 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2350 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) 2351 return false; 2352 2353 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2354 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2355 2356 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2357 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2358 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2359 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2360 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2361 2362 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2363 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2364 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2365 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2366 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2367 return false; 2368 2369 // Conversion between Objective-C pointers. 2370 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2371 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2372 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2373 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2374 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2375 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2376 return false; 2377 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2378 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2379 ToType, Context); 2380 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2381 return true; 2382 } 2383 2384 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2385 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2386 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2387 // complain about it. 2388 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2389 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2390 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2391 ToType, Context); 2392 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2393 return true; 2394 } 2395 } 2396 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2397 QualType ToPointeeType; 2398 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2399 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2400 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2401 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2402 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2403 // to a block pointer type. 2404 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2405 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2406 return true; 2407 } 2408 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2409 } 2410 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2411 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2412 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2413 // pointer to any object. 2414 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2415 return true; 2416 } 2417 else 2418 return false; 2419 2420 QualType FromPointeeType; 2421 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2422 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2423 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2424 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2425 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2426 else 2427 return false; 2428 2429 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2430 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2431 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2432 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2433 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2434 // We always complain about this conversion. 2435 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2436 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2437 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2438 return true; 2439 } 2440 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2441 // as in I* to id. 2442 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2443 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2444 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2445 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2446 2447 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2448 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2449 return true; 2450 } 2451 2452 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2453 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2454 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2455 // complain about it). 2456 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2457 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2458 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2459 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2460 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2461 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2462 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2463 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2464 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2465 return false; 2466 2467 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2468 // function types are obviously different. 2469 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2470 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2471 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals()) 2472 return false; 2473 2474 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2475 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) == 2476 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2477 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2478 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2479 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2480 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2481 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2482 HasObjCConversion = true; 2483 } else { 2484 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2485 return false; 2486 } 2487 2488 // Check argument types. 2489 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2490 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2491 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2492 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2493 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2494 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2495 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2496 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2497 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2498 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2499 HasObjCConversion = true; 2500 } else { 2501 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2502 return false; 2503 } 2504 } 2505 2506 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2507 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2508 // conversion, but complain about it. 2509 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2510 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2511 return true; 2512 } 2513 } 2514 2515 return false; 2516 } 2517 2518 /// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2519 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2520 /// 2521 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2522 /// 2523 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2524 /// 2525 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2526 /// this conversion. 2527 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2528 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2529 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2530 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2531 return false; 2532 2533 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2534 QualType ToPointee; 2535 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2536 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2537 else 2538 return false; 2539 2540 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2541 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2542 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2543 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2544 return false; 2545 2546 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2547 QualType FromPointee; 2548 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2549 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2550 else 2551 return false; 2552 2553 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2554 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2555 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2556 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2557 return false; 2558 2559 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2560 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2561 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2562 return false; 2563 2564 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2565 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2566 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2567 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2568 2569 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2570 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2571 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2572 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2573 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2574 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2575 IncompatibleObjC)) 2576 return false; 2577 2578 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2579 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2580 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2581 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2582 return true; 2583 } 2584 2585 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2586 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2587 QualType ToPointeeType; 2588 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2589 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2590 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2591 else 2592 return false; 2593 2594 QualType FromPointeeType; 2595 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2596 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2597 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2598 else 2599 return false; 2600 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2601 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2602 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2603 2604 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2605 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2606 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2607 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2608 2609 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2610 return false; 2611 2612 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2613 return true; 2614 2615 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2616 // function types are obviously different. 2617 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2618 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2619 return false; 2620 2621 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2622 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2623 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2624 return false; 2625 2626 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2627 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2628 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2629 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2630 } else { 2631 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2632 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2633 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2634 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2635 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2636 2637 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2638 // OK exact match. 2639 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2640 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2641 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2642 return false; 2643 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2644 } 2645 else 2646 return false; 2647 } 2648 2649 // Check argument types. 2650 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2651 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2652 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2653 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2654 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2655 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2656 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2657 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2658 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2659 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2660 return false; 2661 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2662 } else 2663 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2664 return false; 2665 } 2666 if (!Context.doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(FromFunctionType, 2667 ToFunctionType)) 2668 return false; 2669 2670 ConvertedType = ToType; 2671 return true; 2672 } 2673 2674 enum { 2675 ft_default, 2676 ft_different_class, 2677 ft_parameter_arity, 2678 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2679 ft_return_type, 2680 ft_qualifer_mismatch, 2681 ft_noexcept 2682 }; 2683 2684 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles 2685 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly. 2686 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) { 2687 if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 2688 return FPT; 2689 2690 if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 2691 return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2692 2693 return nullptr; 2694 } 2695 2696 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2697 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2698 /// parameter types, and different return types. 2699 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2700 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2701 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2702 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2703 PDiag << ft_default; 2704 return; 2705 } 2706 2707 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2708 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2709 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2710 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2711 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) { 2712 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2713 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2714 return; 2715 } 2716 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2717 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2718 } 2719 2720 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2721 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2722 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2723 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2724 2725 // Remove references. 2726 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2727 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2728 2729 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2730 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2731 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2732 PDiag << ft_default; 2733 return; 2734 } 2735 2736 // No extra info for same types. 2737 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2738 PDiag << ft_default; 2739 return; 2740 } 2741 2742 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType), 2743 *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType); 2744 2745 // Both types need to be function types. 2746 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2747 PDiag << ft_default; 2748 return; 2749 } 2750 2751 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) { 2752 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams() 2753 << FromFunction->getNumParams(); 2754 return; 2755 } 2756 2757 // Handle different parameter types. 2758 unsigned ArgPos; 2759 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2760 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2761 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos) 2762 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos); 2763 return; 2764 } 2765 2766 // Handle different return type. 2767 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(), 2768 ToFunction->getReturnType())) { 2769 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType() 2770 << FromFunction->getReturnType(); 2771 return; 2772 } 2773 2774 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(), 2775 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals(); 2776 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) { 2777 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals; 2778 return; 2779 } 2780 2781 // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17 2782 // onwards). 2783 if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2784 ->isNothrow(Context) != 2785 cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2786 ->isNothrow(Context)) { 2787 PDiag << ft_noexcept; 2788 return; 2789 } 2790 2791 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2792 PDiag << ft_default; 2793 } 2794 2795 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2796 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2797 /// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different, 2798 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter. 2799 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2800 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2801 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2802 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(), 2803 N = NewType->param_type_begin(), 2804 E = OldType->param_type_end(); 2805 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2806 if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(), 2807 N->getUnqualifiedType())) { 2808 if (ArgPos) 2809 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin(); 2810 return false; 2811 } 2812 } 2813 return true; 2814 } 2815 2816 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2817 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2818 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2819 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2820 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2821 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 2822 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2823 CastKind &Kind, 2824 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2825 bool IgnoreBaseAccess, 2826 bool Diagnose) { 2827 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2828 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2829 2830 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2831 2832 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() && 2833 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 2834 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 2835 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy)) 2836 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 2837 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 2838 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 2839 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) 2840 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer) 2841 << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 2842 } 2843 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2844 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2845 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 2846 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 2847 2848 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2849 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2850 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 2851 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 2852 unsigned InaccessibleID = 0; 2853 unsigned AmbigiousID = 0; 2854 if (Diagnose) { 2855 InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base; 2856 AmbigiousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv; 2857 } 2858 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion( 2859 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbigiousID, 2860 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(), 2861 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess)) 2862 return true; 2863 2864 // The conversion was successful. 2865 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 2866 } 2867 2868 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 2869 FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2870 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 2871 "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!"); 2872 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj) 2873 << From->getSourceRange(); 2874 } 2875 } 2876 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 2877 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2878 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 2879 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2880 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 2881 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 2882 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 2883 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 2884 return false; 2885 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 2886 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 2887 } else { 2888 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 2889 } 2890 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 2891 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 2892 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 2893 } 2894 2895 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 2896 // reasons. 2897 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 2898 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 2899 2900 return false; 2901 } 2902 2903 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2904 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 2905 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 2906 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 2907 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 2908 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 2909 QualType ToType, 2910 bool InOverloadResolution, 2911 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2912 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2913 if (!ToTypePtr) 2914 return false; 2915 2916 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 2917 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2918 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2919 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 2920 ConvertedType = ToType; 2921 return true; 2922 } 2923 2924 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 2925 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2926 if (!FromTypePtr) 2927 return false; 2928 2929 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 2930 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 2931 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 2932 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 2933 2934 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 2935 IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, FromClass)) { 2936 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 2937 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 2938 return true; 2939 } 2940 2941 return false; 2942 } 2943 2944 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 2945 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 2946 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 2947 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 2948 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 2949 /// otherwise. 2950 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2951 CastKind &Kind, 2952 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 2953 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 2954 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2955 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2956 if (!FromPtrType) { 2957 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 2958 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2959 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 2960 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 2961 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 2962 return false; 2963 } 2964 2965 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2966 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 2967 "that is not a member pointer."); 2968 2969 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 2970 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 2971 2972 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 2973 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 2974 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 2975 2976 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 2977 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 2978 bool DerivationOkay = 2979 IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 2980 assert(DerivationOkay && 2981 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 2982 (void)DerivationOkay; 2983 2984 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 2985 getUnqualifiedType())) { 2986 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 2987 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 2988 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 2989 return true; 2990 } 2991 2992 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 2993 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 2994 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 2995 << From->getSourceRange(); 2996 return true; 2997 } 2998 2999 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 3000 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 3001 Paths.front(), 3002 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 3003 3004 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 3005 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 3006 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 3007 return false; 3008 } 3009 3010 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given 3011 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial. 3012 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals, 3013 Qualifiers ToQuals) { 3014 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial. 3015 if (ToQuals.hasConst() && 3016 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) 3017 return false; 3018 3019 return true; 3020 } 3021 3022 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 3023 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 3024 /// (C++ 4.4). 3025 /// 3026 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 3027 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 3028 /// object lifetime. 3029 bool 3030 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3031 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3032 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 3033 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 3034 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3035 3036 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 3037 // qualification conversion. 3038 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 3039 return false; 3040 3041 // (C++ 4.4p4): 3042 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 3043 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 3044 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 3045 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 3046 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 3047 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 3048 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 3049 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 3050 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 3051 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to 3052 // unwrap. 3053 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 3054 3055 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 3056 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 3057 3058 // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void. 3059 if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType()) 3060 FromQuals.removeUnaligned(); 3061 3062 // Objective-C ARC: 3063 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 3064 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() && 3065 UnwrappedAnyPointer) { 3066 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 3067 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals)) 3068 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 3069 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3070 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3071 } else { 3072 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 3073 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 3074 return false; 3075 } 3076 } 3077 3078 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 3079 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 3080 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 3081 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3082 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3083 } 3084 3085 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 3086 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 3087 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 3088 return false; 3089 3090 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 3091 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 3092 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() 3093 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 3094 return false; 3095 3096 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 3097 // include const. 3098 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst 3099 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 3100 } 3101 3102 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 3103 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 3104 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 3105 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 3106 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 3107 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 3108 } 3109 3110 /// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 3111 /// atomic type. 3112 /// 3113 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 3114 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 3115 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3116 bool InOverloadResolution, 3117 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 3118 bool CStyle) { 3119 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 3120 if (!ToAtomic) 3121 return false; 3122 3123 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 3124 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 3125 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 3126 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 3127 return false; 3128 3129 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 3130 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 3131 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 3132 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3133 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 3134 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 3135 return true; 3136 } 3137 3138 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 3139 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 3140 QualType Type) { 3141 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType = 3142 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3143 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) { 3144 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0); 3145 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 3146 return true; 3147 } 3148 return false; 3149 } 3150 3151 static OverloadingResult 3152 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3153 CXXRecordDecl *To, 3154 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3155 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3156 bool AllowExplicit) { 3157 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) { 3158 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3159 if (!Info) 3160 continue; 3161 3162 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 3163 S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor) && 3164 (AllowExplicit || !Info.Constructor->isExplicit()); 3165 if (Usable) { 3166 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3167 // suppress conversions. 3168 bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3169 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3170 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3171 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3172 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From, 3173 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3174 else 3175 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From, 3176 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3177 } 3178 } 3179 3180 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3181 3182 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3183 switch (auto Result = 3184 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), 3185 Best, true)) { 3186 case OR_Deleted: 3187 case OR_Success: { 3188 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3189 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 3190 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 3191 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3192 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3193 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3194 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3195 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3196 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3197 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3198 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3199 return Result; 3200 } 3201 3202 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3203 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3204 case OR_Ambiguous: 3205 return OR_Ambiguous; 3206 } 3207 3208 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3209 } 3210 3211 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 3212 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 3213 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 3214 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 3215 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 3216 /// false and User is unspecified. 3217 /// 3218 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 3219 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 3220 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 3221 /// 3222 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should 3223 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit 3224 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set. 3225 static OverloadingResult 3226 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3227 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3228 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3229 bool AllowExplicit, 3230 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 3231 assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3232 3233 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 3234 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 3235 3236 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 3237 // constructors. 3238 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3239 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 3240 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 3241 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 3242 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 3243 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 3244 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 3245 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 3246 // the parentheses of the initializer. 3247 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 3248 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 3249 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), ToType))) 3250 ConstructorsOnly = true; 3251 3252 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) { 3253 // We're not going to find any constructors. 3254 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 3255 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 3256 3257 Expr **Args = &From; 3258 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 3259 bool ListInitializing = false; 3260 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3261 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work. 3262 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 3263 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit); 3264 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 3265 return Result; 3266 // Never mind. 3267 CandidateSet.clear(); 3268 3269 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 3270 // arguments, not the entire list. 3271 Args = InitList->getInits(); 3272 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 3273 ListInitializing = true; 3274 } 3275 3276 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) { 3277 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3278 if (!Info) 3279 continue; 3280 3281 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 3282 if (ListInitializing) 3283 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Info.Constructor->isExplicit()); 3284 else 3285 Usable = Usable && 3286 Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit); 3287 if (Usable) { 3288 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 3289 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 3290 SuppressUserConversions = false; 3291 if (NumArgs == 1) { 3292 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3293 // suppress conversions. 3294 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3295 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3296 } 3297 } 3298 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3299 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 3300 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3301 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3302 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3303 else 3304 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 3305 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 3306 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, 3307 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3308 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3309 } 3310 } 3311 } 3312 } 3313 3314 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 3315 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3316 } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType())) { 3317 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 3318 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType 3319 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3320 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 3321 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 3322 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 3323 const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3324 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 3325 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 3326 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3327 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3328 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3329 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3330 3331 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3332 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 3333 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 3334 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3335 else 3336 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3337 3338 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 3339 if (ConvTemplate) 3340 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, 3341 ActingContext, From, ToType, 3342 CandidateSet, 3343 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3344 else 3345 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 3346 From, ToType, CandidateSet, 3347 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3348 } 3349 } 3350 } 3351 } 3352 3353 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3354 3355 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3356 switch (auto Result = CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), 3357 Best, true)) { 3358 case OR_Success: 3359 case OR_Deleted: 3360 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3361 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 3362 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3363 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3364 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3365 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 3366 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 3367 // the argument of the constructor. 3368 // 3369 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 3370 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3371 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3372 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3373 } else { 3374 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 3375 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 3376 else { 3377 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3378 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3379 } 3380 } 3381 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3382 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3383 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3384 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3385 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3386 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3387 return Result; 3388 } 3389 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3390 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3391 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3392 // 3393 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3394 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3395 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3396 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3397 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3398 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3399 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3400 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3401 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3402 3403 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3404 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3405 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3406 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3407 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3408 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3409 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3410 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3411 // 13.3.3.1). 3412 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3413 return Result; 3414 } 3415 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3416 3417 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3418 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3419 3420 case OR_Ambiguous: 3421 return OR_Ambiguous; 3422 } 3423 3424 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3425 } 3426 3427 bool 3428 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3429 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3430 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(), 3431 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 3432 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3433 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3434 CandidateSet, false, false); 3435 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3436 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3437 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3438 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) { 3439 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 3440 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete, 3441 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange())) 3442 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3443 << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType; 3444 } else 3445 return false; 3446 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From); 3447 return true; 3448 } 3449 3450 /// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3451 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3452 /// is possible. 3453 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3454 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1, 3455 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3456 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 3457 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3458 3459 // Objective-C++: 3460 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3461 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3462 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3463 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3464 // to keep code working. 3465 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3466 if (!Conv1) 3467 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3468 3469 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3470 if (!Conv2) 3471 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3472 3473 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) { 3474 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3475 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3476 if (Block1 != Block2) 3477 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3478 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3479 } 3480 3481 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3482 } 3483 3484 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion( 3485 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 3486 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) || 3487 (ICS.isUserDefined() && 3488 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr); 3489 } 3490 3491 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3492 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3493 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3494 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3495 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3496 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3497 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3498 { 3499 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3500 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3501 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3502 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3503 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3504 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3505 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3506 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3507 // 3508 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3509 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3510 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3511 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3512 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3513 3514 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has 3515 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at 3516 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse 3517 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the 3518 // standard. For example: 3519 // 3520 // int &f(...); // #1 3521 // void f(char*); // #2 3522 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); } 3523 // 3524 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function. 3525 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis 3526 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there 3527 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't 3528 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11. 3529 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued 3530 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11. 3531 3532 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 3533 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) != 3534 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2)) 3535 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) 3536 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3537 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3538 3539 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3540 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3541 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3542 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3543 3544 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3545 // the same kind. 3546 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3547 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3548 3549 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3550 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3551 3552 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3553 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3554 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3555 3556 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3557 // list-initialization sequence L2 if: 3558 // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or, 3559 // if not that, 3560 // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T", 3561 // and N1 is smaller than N2., 3562 // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply. 3563 if (!ICS1.isBad()) { 3564 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3565 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3566 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3567 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3568 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3569 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3570 } 3571 3572 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3573 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than 3574 // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...] 3575 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3576 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3577 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3578 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3579 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3580 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3581 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3582 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3583 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3584 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3585 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3586 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3587 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3588 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3589 else 3590 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3591 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3592 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3593 } 3594 3595 return Result; 3596 } 3597 3598 static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) { 3599 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 3600 Qualifiers Quals; 3601 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals); 3602 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals); 3603 } 3604 3605 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2); 3606 } 3607 3608 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3609 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3610 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3611 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3612 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3613 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3614 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3615 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3616 3617 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3618 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3619 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3620 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3621 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3622 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3623 3624 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3625 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3626 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3627 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3628 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3629 else 3630 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3631 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3632 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3633 3634 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3635 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3636 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3637 } 3638 3639 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3640 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3641 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3642 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3643 3644 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3645 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3646 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3647 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3648 3649 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3650 } 3651 3652 /// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3653 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3654 static bool 3655 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3656 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3657 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3658 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3659 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3660 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3661 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3662 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3663 // reference*. 3664 // 3665 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3666 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3667 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3668 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3669 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3670 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3671 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3672 return false; 3673 3674 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3675 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3676 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3677 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue); 3678 } 3679 3680 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3681 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3682 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3683 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3684 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3685 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3686 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3687 { 3688 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3689 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3690 3691 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3692 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3693 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3694 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3695 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3696 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3697 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3698 return CK; 3699 3700 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3701 // defined below), or, if not that, 3702 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3703 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3704 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3705 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3706 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3707 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3708 3709 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3710 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3711 // applies: 3712 3713 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3714 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3715 // that is such a conversion. 3716 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3717 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3718 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3719 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3720 3721 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3722 // 3723 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3724 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 3725 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 3726 // of B* to void*. 3727 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 3728 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3729 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 3730 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3731 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3732 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 3733 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 3734 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3735 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3736 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3737 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 3738 // their derived-to-base conversions. 3739 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 3740 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2)) 3741 return DerivedCK; 3742 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 3743 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 3744 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 3745 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 3746 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 3747 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3748 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3749 3750 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3751 // conversion, if we need to. 3752 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3753 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3754 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3755 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3756 3757 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3758 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3759 3760 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3761 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3762 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3763 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3764 3765 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 3766 // other, it is the better one. 3767 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 3768 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3769 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 3770 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3771 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 3772 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 3773 FromObjCPtr2); 3774 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 3775 FromObjCPtr1); 3776 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 3777 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3778 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3779 } 3780 } 3781 } 3782 3783 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 3784 // bullet 3). 3785 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 3786 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 3787 return QualCK; 3788 3789 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 3790 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 3791 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 3792 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3793 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 3794 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3795 3796 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3797 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 3798 // which the references refer are the same type except for 3799 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 3800 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 3801 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 3802 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 3803 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 3804 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 3805 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 3806 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3807 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3808 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3809 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 3810 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 3811 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 3812 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 3813 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 3814 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 3815 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3816 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3817 } 3818 3819 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 3820 // type for comparison. 3821 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3822 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3823 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3824 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3825 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 3826 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3827 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 3828 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3829 } 3830 } 3831 3832 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 3833 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 3834 // is between types of the same size. 3835 // For example: 3836 // void f(float); 3837 // void f(int); 3838 // int main { 3839 // long a; 3840 // f(a); 3841 // } 3842 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 3843 // as clang will do in standard mode. 3844 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 3845 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 3846 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 3847 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 3848 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3849 3850 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3851 } 3852 3853 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 3854 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 3855 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 3856 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3857 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 3858 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3859 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3860 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 3861 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 3862 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 3863 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 3864 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 3865 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 3866 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 3867 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 3868 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3869 3870 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 3871 // conversion (!) 3872 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 3873 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 3874 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 3875 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 3876 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3877 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3878 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3879 3880 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped 3881 // them. 3882 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 3883 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3884 3885 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 3886 // for comparison. 3887 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3888 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3889 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3890 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3891 3892 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3893 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3894 3895 // Objective-C++ ARC: 3896 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 3897 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 3898 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 3899 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 3900 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3901 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3902 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3903 } 3904 3905 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 3906 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 3907 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 3908 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 3909 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 3910 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 3911 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 3912 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 3913 // strict subset of qualifiers. 3914 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers()) 3915 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 3916 // about how the sequences rank. 3917 ; 3918 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 3919 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 3920 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 3921 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 3922 // qualifiers. 3923 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3924 3925 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3926 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 3927 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 3928 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 3929 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 3930 // qualifiers. 3931 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3932 3933 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3934 } else { 3935 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 3936 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3937 } 3938 3939 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 3940 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 3941 break; 3942 } 3943 3944 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 3945 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 3946 switch (Result) { 3947 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 3948 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 3949 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3950 break; 3951 3952 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 3953 break; 3954 3955 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 3956 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 3957 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3958 break; 3959 } 3960 3961 return Result; 3962 } 3963 3964 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 3965 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 3966 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 3967 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 3968 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 3969 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3970 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3971 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3972 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3973 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3974 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 3975 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3976 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 3977 3978 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3979 // conversion, if we need to. 3980 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3981 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3982 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3983 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3984 3985 // Canonicalize all of the types. 3986 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 3987 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 3988 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 3989 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 3990 3991 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 3992 // 3993 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 3994 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 3995 // 3996 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 3997 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 3998 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 3999 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 4000 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 4001 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 4002 QualType FromPointee1 4003 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4004 QualType ToPointee1 4005 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4006 QualType FromPointee2 4007 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4008 QualType ToPointee2 4009 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4010 4011 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4012 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4013 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4014 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4015 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4016 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4017 } 4018 4019 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4020 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 4021 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4022 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4023 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4024 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4025 } 4026 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4027 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 4028 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 4029 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4030 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 4031 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4032 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 4033 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4034 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 4035 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4036 4037 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 4038 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 4039 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 4040 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 4041 // Objective-C pointer types. 4042 bool FromAssignLeft 4043 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 4044 bool FromAssignRight 4045 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 4046 bool ToAssignLeft 4047 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 4048 bool ToAssignRight 4049 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 4050 4051 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 4052 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 4053 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 4054 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4055 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4056 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 4057 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4058 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4059 4060 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 4061 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 4062 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4063 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4064 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4065 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4066 4067 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 4068 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 4069 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4070 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4071 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4072 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 4073 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4074 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4075 4076 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 4077 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 4078 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4079 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4080 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4081 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4082 4083 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4084 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4085 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4086 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) { 4087 if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) { 4088 // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to 4089 // C *. 4090 bool IsFirstSame = 4091 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl(); 4092 bool IsSecondSame = 4093 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl(); 4094 if (IsFirstSame) { 4095 if (!IsSecondSame) 4096 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4097 } else if (IsSecondSame) 4098 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4099 } 4100 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4101 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4102 } 4103 4104 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4105 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 4106 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 4107 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4108 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4109 } 4110 } 4111 4112 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 4113 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 4114 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 4115 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 4116 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 = 4117 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4118 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 = 4119 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4120 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 = 4121 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4122 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 = 4123 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4124 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 4125 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 4126 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 4127 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 4128 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4129 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4130 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4131 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4132 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 4133 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4134 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4135 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4136 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4137 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4138 } 4139 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 4140 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 4141 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4142 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4143 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4144 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4145 } 4146 } 4147 4148 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4149 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 4150 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 4151 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4152 // reference of type A&, 4153 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4154 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4155 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2)) 4156 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4157 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1)) 4158 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4159 } 4160 4161 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 4162 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 4163 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4164 // reference of type A&, 4165 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4166 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4167 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1)) 4168 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4169 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2)) 4170 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4171 } 4172 } 4173 4174 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4175 } 4176 4177 /// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid 4178 /// C++ class. 4179 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) { 4180 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 4181 return !Record->isInvalidDecl(); 4182 4183 return true; 4184 } 4185 4186 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 4187 /// determine whether they are reference-related, 4188 /// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added 4189 /// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 4190 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 4191 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 4192 /// type being initialized. 4193 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 4194 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 4195 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 4196 bool &DerivedToBase, 4197 bool &ObjCConversion, 4198 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 4199 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 4200 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 4201 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 4202 4203 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 4204 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 4205 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4206 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4207 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4208 4209 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4210 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 4211 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or 4212 // T1 is a base class of T2. 4213 DerivedToBase = false; 4214 ObjCConversion = false; 4215 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4216 QualType ConvertedT2; 4217 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4218 // Nothing to do. 4219 } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) && 4220 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) && 4221 IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 4222 DerivedToBase = true; 4223 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4224 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4225 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 4226 ObjCConversion = true; 4227 else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() && 4228 IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) 4229 // C++1z [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4230 // cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if [...] T2 is "noexcept 4231 // function" and T1 is "function" 4232 // 4233 // We extend this to also apply to 'noreturn', so allow any function 4234 // conversion between function types. 4235 return Ref_Compatible; 4236 else 4237 return Ref_Incompatible; 4238 4239 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at 4240 // least). 4241 4242 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 4243 // for comparison. 4244 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 4245 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 4246 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 4247 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 4248 4249 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4250 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is 4251 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification 4252 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of 4253 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater 4254 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as 4255 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2). 4256 // 4257 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space 4258 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in 4259 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address 4260 // space 2. 4261 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() && 4262 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) { 4263 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(T2Quals, T1Quals)) 4264 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 4265 4266 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4267 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4268 } 4269 4270 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4271 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4272 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4273 4274 if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4275 return Ref_Compatible; 4276 else 4277 return Ref_Related; 4278 } 4279 4280 /// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible 4281 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 4282 static bool 4283 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 4284 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4285 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 4286 bool AllowExplicit) { 4287 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 4288 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl 4289 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 4290 4291 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 4292 const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4293 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 4294 NamedDecl *D = *I; 4295 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 4296 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4297 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4298 4299 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 4300 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 4301 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 4302 if (ConvTemplate) 4303 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 4304 else 4305 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4306 4307 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider 4308 // explicit conversions, skip it. 4309 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit()) 4310 continue; 4311 4312 if (AllowRvalues) { 4313 bool DerivedToBase = false; 4314 bool ObjCConversion = false; 4315 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4316 4317 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 4318 // functions that return lvalues. 4319 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4320 const ReferenceType *RefType 4321 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4322 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 4323 continue; 4324 } 4325 4326 if (!ConvTemplate && 4327 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 4328 DeclLoc, 4329 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType() 4330 .getUnqualifiedType(), 4331 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(), 4332 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) == 4333 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4334 continue; 4335 } else { 4336 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 4337 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 4338 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 4339 4340 const ReferenceType *RefType = 4341 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 4342 if (!RefType || 4343 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 4344 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 4345 continue; 4346 } 4347 4348 if (ConvTemplate) 4349 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, 4350 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4351 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4352 else 4353 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, 4354 DeclType, CandidateSet, 4355 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4356 } 4357 4358 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 4359 4360 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4361 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) { 4362 case OR_Success: 4363 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4364 // 4365 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 4366 // applying a conversion function to the argument 4367 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 4368 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 4369 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 4370 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 4371 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 4372 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 4373 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 4374 return false; 4375 4376 ICS.setUserDefined(); 4377 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 4378 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 4379 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 4380 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 4381 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 4382 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4383 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 4384 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 4385 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 4386 return true; 4387 4388 case OR_Ambiguous: 4389 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 4390 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 4391 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 4392 if (Cand->Viable) 4393 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 4394 return true; 4395 4396 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 4397 case OR_Deleted: 4398 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 4399 // conversion; continue with other checks. 4400 return false; 4401 } 4402 4403 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 4404 } 4405 4406 /// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 4407 /// initialization. 4408 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4409 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 4410 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4411 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4412 bool AllowExplicit) { 4413 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 4414 4415 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 4416 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4417 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4418 4419 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4420 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4421 4422 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4423 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4424 // type of the resulting function. 4425 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4426 DeclAccessPair Found; 4427 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 4428 false, Found)) 4429 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4430 } 4431 4432 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4433 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 4434 bool DerivedToBase = false; 4435 bool ObjCConversion = false; 4436 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4437 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 4438 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 4439 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase, 4440 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion); 4441 4442 4443 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 4444 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 4445 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 4446 4447 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 4448 if (!isRValRef) { 4449 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 4450 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 4451 // 4452 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 4453 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) { 4454 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4455 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4456 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4457 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4458 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4459 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4460 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4461 ICS.setStandard(); 4462 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4463 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4464 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4465 : ICK_Identity; 4466 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 4467 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4468 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4469 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4470 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4471 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4472 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 4473 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4474 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4475 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false; 4476 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4477 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 4478 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4479 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4480 4481 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4482 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4483 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4484 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4485 return ICS; 4486 } 4487 4488 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4489 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4490 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4491 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4492 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4493 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4494 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4495 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4496 S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4497 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4498 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4499 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4500 AllowExplicit)) 4501 return ICS; 4502 } 4503 } 4504 4505 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4506 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4507 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4508 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) 4509 return ICS; 4510 4511 // -- If the initializer expression 4512 // 4513 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4514 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4515 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible && 4516 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4517 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4518 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4519 ICS.setStandard(); 4520 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4521 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4522 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4523 : ICK_Identity; 4524 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 4525 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4526 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4527 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4528 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4529 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4530 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4531 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4532 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4533 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4534 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4535 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = 4536 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || 4537 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType()); 4538 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4539 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4540 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4541 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4542 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 4543 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4544 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4545 return ICS; 4546 } 4547 4548 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4549 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4550 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4551 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4552 // "cv3 T3", 4553 // 4554 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4555 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4556 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4557 // class subobject). 4558 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4559 T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4560 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4561 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4562 AllowExplicit)) { 4563 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4564 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4565 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4566 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4567 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4568 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4569 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4570 4571 return ICS; 4572 } 4573 4574 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try. 4575 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 4576 return ICS; 4577 4578 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4579 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4580 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4581 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4582 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4583 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4584 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4585 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4586 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4587 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4588 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4589 // initialization fails. 4590 // 4591 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4592 // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important. 4593 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4594 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4595 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4596 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4597 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4598 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4599 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4600 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4601 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4602 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4603 return ICS; 4604 } 4605 4606 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4607 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4608 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4609 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4610 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4611 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4612 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4613 return ICS; 4614 4615 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4616 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4617 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && 4618 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) 4619 return ICS; 4620 4621 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4622 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4623 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4624 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4625 // underlying type of the reference according to 4626 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4627 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4628 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4629 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4630 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4631 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4632 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4633 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4634 /*CStyle=*/false, 4635 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4636 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4637 4638 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4639 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4640 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4641 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4642 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4643 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4644 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4645 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4646 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4647 const ReferenceType *LValRefType = 4648 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType() 4649 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4650 4651 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3: 4652 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a 4653 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...] 4654 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function 4655 // lvalue. 4656 // Note that the function case is not possible here. 4657 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) { 4658 // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding 4659 // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue 4660 // reference to an rvalue! 4661 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType); 4662 return ICS; 4663 } 4664 4665 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4666 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4667 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4668 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType; 4669 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4670 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4671 } 4672 4673 return ICS; 4674 } 4675 4676 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4677 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4678 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4679 bool InOverloadResolution, 4680 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4681 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4682 4683 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4684 /// initializer list From. 4685 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4686 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 4687 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4688 bool InOverloadResolution, 4689 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 4690 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 4691 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 4692 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 4693 4694 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 4695 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 4696 4697 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 4698 // initialized from init lists. 4699 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType)) 4700 return Result; 4701 4702 // Per DR1467: 4703 // If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single 4704 // element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the 4705 // implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element 4706 // to the parameter type. 4707 // 4708 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ] 4709 // and the initializer list has a single element that is an 4710 // appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the 4711 // implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion. 4712 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4713 if (ToType->isRecordType()) { 4714 QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType(); 4715 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) || 4716 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), InitType, ToType)) 4717 return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4718 SuppressUserConversions, 4719 InOverloadResolution, 4720 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4721 } 4722 // FIXME: Check the other conditions here: array of character type, 4723 // initializer is a string literal. 4724 if (ToType->isArrayType()) { 4725 InitializedEntity Entity = 4726 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4727 /*Consumed=*/false); 4728 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 4729 Result.setStandard(); 4730 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4731 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4732 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4733 return Result; 4734 } 4735 } 4736 } 4737 4738 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below). 4739 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 4740 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 4741 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 4742 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 4743 // element of the list to X. 4744 // 4745 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3: 4746 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer 4747 // list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is 4748 // default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list 4749 // can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is 4750 // the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X. 4751 // 4752 // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks. 4753 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 4754 QualType X; 4755 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 4756 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType(); 4757 else 4758 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 4759 if (!X.isNull()) { 4760 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 4761 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 4762 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4763 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 4764 InOverloadResolution, 4765 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4766 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 4767 if (ICS.isBad()) { 4768 Result = ICS; 4769 break; 4770 } 4771 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 4772 if (Result.isBad() || 4773 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, From->getLocStart(), ICS, 4774 Result) == 4775 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4776 Result = ICS; 4777 } 4778 4779 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 4780 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 4781 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 4782 Result.setStandard(); 4783 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4784 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4785 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4786 } 4787 4788 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 4789 return Result; 4790 } 4791 4792 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4: 4793 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 4794 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 4795 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 4796 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 4797 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 4798 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 4799 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 4800 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 4801 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 4802 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4803 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 4804 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4805 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4806 } 4807 4808 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5: 4809 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 4810 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 4811 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 4812 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 4813 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 4814 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 4815 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 4816 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 4817 // FIXME: Expose SemaInit's aggregate initialization code so that we don't 4818 // need to call into the initialization code here; overload resolution 4819 // should not be doing that. 4820 InitializedEntity Entity = 4821 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4822 /*Consumed=*/false); 4823 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 4824 Result.setUserDefined(); 4825 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4826 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 4827 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 4828 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 4829 4830 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4831 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 4832 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4833 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr; 4834 } 4835 return Result; 4836 } 4837 4838 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6: 4839 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 4840 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 4841 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 4842 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 4843 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 4844 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 4845 4846 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4847 4848 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 4849 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 4850 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4851 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 4852 4853 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4854 4855 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4856 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4857 // type of the resulting function. 4858 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4859 DeclAccessPair Found; 4860 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 4861 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 4862 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4863 } 4864 4865 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4866 bool dummy1 = false; 4867 bool dummy2 = false; 4868 bool dummy3 = false; 4869 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 4870 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1, 4871 dummy2, dummy3); 4872 4873 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) { 4874 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(), 4875 SuppressUserConversions, 4876 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 4877 } 4878 } 4879 4880 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 4881 // initializer list. 4882 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4883 InOverloadResolution, 4884 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4885 if (Result.isFailure()) 4886 return Result; 4887 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 4888 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 4889 4890 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 4891 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 4892 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 4893 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 4894 Result.UserDefined.After; 4895 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 4896 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 4897 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 4898 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4899 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4900 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4901 } else 4902 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 4903 From, ToType); 4904 return Result; 4905 } 4906 4907 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7: 4908 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 4909 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 4910 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 4911 // - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an 4912 // initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one 4913 // required to convert the element to the parameter type. 4914 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 4915 if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0))) 4916 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4917 SuppressUserConversions, 4918 InOverloadResolution, 4919 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4920 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 4921 // sequence is the identity conversion. 4922 else if (NumInits == 0) { 4923 Result.setStandard(); 4924 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4925 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4926 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4927 } 4928 return Result; 4929 } 4930 4931 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8: 4932 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 4933 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 4934 return Result; 4935 } 4936 4937 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 4938 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 4939 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 4940 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 4941 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 4942 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 4943 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4944 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4945 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4946 bool InOverloadResolution, 4947 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4948 bool AllowExplicit) { 4949 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 4950 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 4951 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4952 4953 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 4954 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 4955 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(), 4956 SuppressUserConversions, 4957 AllowExplicit); 4958 4959 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 4960 SuppressUserConversions, 4961 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4962 InOverloadResolution, 4963 /*CStyle=*/false, 4964 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4965 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4966 } 4967 4968 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 4969 const CanQualType ToQTy, 4970 Sema &S, 4971 SourceLocation Loc, 4972 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 4973 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 4974 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4975 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 4976 4977 return !ICS.isBad(); 4978 } 4979 4980 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 4981 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 4982 /// expression @p From. 4983 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4984 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType, 4985 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 4986 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 4987 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 4988 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 4989 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 4990 // const volatile object. 4991 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ? 4992 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers(); 4993 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 4994 4995 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 4996 // to exit early. 4997 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4998 4999 // We need to have an object of class type. 5000 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5001 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5002 5003 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 5004 // better have an lvalue. 5005 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 5006 } 5007 5008 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 5009 5010 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 5011 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 5012 // parameter is 5013 // 5014 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 5015 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 5016 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 5017 // ref-qualifier 5018 // 5019 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 5020 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 5021 // 5022 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 5023 // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions 5024 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 5025 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 5026 // non-constant references. 5027 5028 // First check the qualifiers. 5029 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 5030 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 5031 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 5032 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 5033 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5034 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5035 return ICS; 5036 } 5037 5038 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 5039 // affects the conversion rank. 5040 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 5041 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 5042 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 5043 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 5044 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType)) 5045 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 5046 else { 5047 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 5048 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5049 return ICS; 5050 } 5051 5052 // Check the ref-qualifier. 5053 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 5054 case RQ_None: 5055 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 5056 break; 5057 5058 case RQ_LValue: 5059 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) { 5060 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 5061 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 5062 ImplicitParamType); 5063 return ICS; 5064 } 5065 break; 5066 5067 case RQ_RValue: 5068 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 5069 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 5070 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 5071 ImplicitParamType); 5072 return ICS; 5073 } 5074 break; 5075 } 5076 5077 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 5078 ICS.setStandard(); 5079 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5080 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 5081 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 5082 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 5083 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 5084 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 5085 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 5086 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5087 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 5088 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 5089 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 5090 return ICS; 5091 } 5092 5093 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 5094 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 5095 /// expression. 5096 ExprResult 5097 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 5098 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 5099 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 5100 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 5101 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 5102 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 5103 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5104 5105 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 5106 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5107 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5108 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 5109 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 5110 } else { 5111 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 5112 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 5113 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 5114 } 5115 5116 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 5117 // the actual argument initialization. 5118 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 5119 *this, From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, 5120 Method->getParent()); 5121 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5122 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) { 5123 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 5124 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 5125 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 5126 if (CVR) { 5127 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5128 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 5129 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 5130 << From->getSourceRange(); 5131 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5132 << Method->getDeclName(); 5133 return ExprError(); 5134 } 5135 } 5136 5137 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5138 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init) 5139 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange(); 5140 } 5141 5142 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 5143 ExprResult FromRes = 5144 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 5145 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 5146 return ExprError(); 5147 From = FromRes.get(); 5148 } 5149 5150 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) 5151 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp, 5152 From->getValueKind()).get(); 5153 return From; 5154 } 5155 5156 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 5157 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5158 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5159 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5160 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 5161 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5162 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 5163 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5164 /*CStyle=*/false, 5165 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5166 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5167 } 5168 5169 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 5170 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5171 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 5172 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5173 return ExprError(); 5174 5175 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 5176 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5177 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 5178 5179 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 5180 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5181 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 5182 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 5183 return ExprError(); 5184 } 5185 5186 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 5187 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 5188 /// is acceptable. 5189 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 5190 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5191 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 5192 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 5193 // conversions are fine. 5194 switch (SCS.Second) { 5195 case ICK_Identity: 5196 case ICK_Function_Conversion: 5197 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 5198 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere. 5199 case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion: 5200 return true; 5201 5202 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 5203 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 5204 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral 5205 // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression. 5206 // 5207 // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks 5208 // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this 5209 // (non-conforming) extension. 5210 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 5211 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 5212 5213 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 5214 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 5215 // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are 5216 // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t. 5217 return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType(); 5218 5219 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 5220 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 5221 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 5222 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 5223 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 5224 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 5225 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 5226 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 5227 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 5228 case ICK_Complex_Real: 5229 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 5230 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 5231 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 5232 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion: 5233 case ICK_C_Only_Conversion: 5234 case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion: 5235 return false; 5236 5237 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 5238 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 5239 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 5240 llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second"); 5241 5242 case ICK_Qualification: 5243 llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second"); 5244 5245 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 5246 break; 5247 } 5248 5249 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 5250 } 5251 5252 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 5253 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 5254 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 5255 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From, 5256 QualType T, APValue &Value, 5257 Sema::CCEKind CCE, 5258 bool RequireInt) { 5259 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 5260 "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 5261 5262 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From)) 5263 return ExprError(); 5264 5265 // C++1z [expr.const]p3: 5266 // A converted constant expression of type T is an expression, 5267 // implicitly converted to type T, where the converted 5268 // expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion 5269 // sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...]. 5270 // C++1z [stmt.if]p2: 5271 // If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the 5272 // condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type 5273 // bool. 5274 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5275 CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf 5276 ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From) 5277 : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T, 5278 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5279 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5280 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false, 5281 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5282 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr; 5283 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5284 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5285 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 5286 break; 5287 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5288 // We are converting to a non-class type, so the Before sequence 5289 // must be trivial. 5290 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 5291 break; 5292 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5293 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5294 if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 5295 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5296 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 5297 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5298 return ExprError(); 5299 5300 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5301 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 5302 } 5303 5304 // Check that we would only use permitted conversions. 5305 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) { 5306 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5307 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 5308 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5309 } 5310 // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly. 5311 if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) { 5312 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5313 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect) 5314 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5315 } 5316 5317 ExprResult Result = 5318 S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting); 5319 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5320 return Result; 5321 5322 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 5323 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 5324 QualType PreNarrowingType; 5325 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 5326 PreNarrowingType)) { 5327 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 5328 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 5329 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 5330 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 5331 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 5332 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 5333 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 5334 break; 5335 5336 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 5337 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5338 << CCE << /*Constant*/1 5339 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 5340 break; 5341 5342 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 5343 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5344 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T; 5345 break; 5346 } 5347 5348 if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) { 5349 Value = APValue(); 5350 return Result; 5351 } 5352 5353 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 5354 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 5355 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 5356 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 5357 5358 if ((T->isReferenceType() 5359 ? !Result.get()->EvaluateAsLValue(Eval, S.Context) 5360 : !Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, S.Context)) || 5361 (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) { 5362 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 5363 // the AST. 5364 Result = ExprError(); 5365 } else { 5366 Value = Eval.Val; 5367 5368 if (Notes.empty()) { 5369 // It's a constant expression. 5370 return Result; 5371 } 5372 } 5373 5374 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 5375 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 5376 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) 5377 S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 5378 else { 5379 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 5380 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 5381 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5382 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5383 } 5384 return ExprError(); 5385 } 5386 5387 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5388 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE) { 5389 return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false); 5390 } 5391 5392 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5393 llvm::APSInt &Value, 5394 CCEKind CCE) { 5395 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 5396 5397 APValue V; 5398 auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true); 5399 if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent()) 5400 Value = V.getInt(); 5401 return R; 5402 } 5403 5404 5405 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 5406 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 5407 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 5408 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5409 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 5410 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 5411 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 5412 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 5413 } 5414 } 5415 5416 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 5417 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5418 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5419 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5420 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 5421 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 5422 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 5423 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 5424 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 5425 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5426 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 5427 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5428 /*CStyle=*/false, 5429 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5430 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true); 5431 5432 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 5433 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5434 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5435 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5436 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5437 break; 5438 5439 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5440 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 5441 break; 5442 5443 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5444 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 5445 break; 5446 } 5447 5448 return ICS; 5449 } 5450 5451 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 5452 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5453 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists. 5454 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 5455 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5456 return ExprError(); 5457 5458 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5459 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5460 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 5461 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5462 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 5463 return ExprResult(); 5464 } 5465 5466 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 5467 /// type of a permitted flavor. 5468 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) { 5469 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 5470 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 5471 } 5472 5473 static ExprResult 5474 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5475 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5476 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) { 5477 5478 if (Converter.Suppress) 5479 return ExprError(); 5480 5481 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5482 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5483 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = 5484 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5485 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5486 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy); 5487 } 5488 return From; 5489 } 5490 5491 static bool 5492 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5493 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5494 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5495 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) { 5496 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) { 5497 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5498 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5499 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5500 5501 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5502 // conversion; use it. 5503 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5504 std::string TypeStr; 5505 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy()); 5506 5507 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy) 5508 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(), 5509 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5510 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 5511 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")"); 5512 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy); 5513 5514 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5515 // explicit conversion function. 5516 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5517 return true; 5518 5519 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5520 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5521 HadMultipleCandidates); 5522 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5523 return true; 5524 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5525 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5526 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5527 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5528 } 5529 return false; 5530 } 5531 5532 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5533 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5534 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5535 DeclAccessPair &Found) { 5536 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5537 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5538 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5539 5540 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5541 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) { 5542 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5543 return true; 5544 5545 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType) 5546 << From->getSourceRange(); 5547 } 5548 5549 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5550 HadMultipleCandidates); 5551 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5552 return true; 5553 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5554 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5555 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5556 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5557 return false; 5558 } 5559 5560 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion( 5561 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5562 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5563 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress) 5564 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType()) 5565 << From->getSourceRange(); 5566 5567 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5568 } 5569 5570 static void 5571 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5572 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions, 5573 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5574 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5575 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I]; 5576 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5577 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 5578 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 5579 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 5580 5581 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 5582 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 5583 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 5584 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5585 else 5586 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5587 5588 if (ConvTemplate) 5589 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 5590 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 5591 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5592 else 5593 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, 5594 ToType, CandidateSet, 5595 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5596 } 5597 } 5598 5599 /// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted 5600 /// by the given converter. 5601 /// 5602 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a 5603 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class 5604 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching 5605 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only 5606 /// one target type. 5607 /// 5608 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 5609 /// conversion. 5610 /// 5611 /// \param From The expression we're converting from. 5612 /// 5613 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process. 5614 /// 5615 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 5616 /// successful. 5617 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion( 5618 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5619 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 5620 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 5621 return From; 5622 5623 // Process placeholders immediately. 5624 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 5625 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 5626 if (result.isInvalid()) 5627 return result; 5628 From = result.get(); 5629 } 5630 5631 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden. 5632 QualType T = From->getType(); 5633 if (Converter.match(T)) 5634 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5635 5636 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 5637 5638 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class 5639 // type. 5640 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 5641 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5642 if (!Converter.Suppress) 5643 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5644 return From; 5645 } 5646 5647 // We must have a complete class type. 5648 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 5649 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter; 5650 Expr *From; 5651 5652 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From) 5653 : Converter(Converter), From(From) {} 5654 5655 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 5656 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5657 } 5658 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From); 5659 5660 if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T) 5661 : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 5662 return From; 5663 5664 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 5665 UnresolvedSet<4> 5666 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y. 5667 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 5668 const auto &Conversions = 5669 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 5670 5671 bool HadMultipleCandidates = 5672 (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1); 5673 5674 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y: 5675 QualType ToType; 5676 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true; 5677 5678 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions. 5679 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 5680 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5681 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion; 5682 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 5683 if (ConvTemplate) { 5684 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) 5685 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5686 else 5687 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?). 5688 } else 5689 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5690 5691 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) && 5692 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially " 5693 "viable in C++1y"); 5694 5695 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5696 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) { 5697 5698 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) { 5699 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction? 5700 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion() 5701 if (!ConvTemplate) 5702 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5703 } else { 5704 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 5705 if (ToType.isNull()) 5706 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 5707 else if (HasUniqueTargetType && 5708 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType)) 5709 HasUniqueTargetType = false; 5710 } 5711 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5712 } 5713 } 5714 } 5715 5716 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 5717 // C++1y [conv]p6: 5718 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context 5719 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified 5720 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly 5721 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched 5722 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to 5723 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be 5724 // exactly one such T. 5725 5726 // If no unique T is found: 5727 if (ToType.isNull()) { 5728 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5729 HadMultipleCandidates, 5730 ExplicitConversions)) 5731 return ExprError(); 5732 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 5733 } 5734 5735 // If more than one unique Ts are found: 5736 if (!HasUniqueTargetType) 5737 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5738 ViableConversions); 5739 5740 // If one unique T is found: 5741 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded 5742 // potentially viable conversions. 5743 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 5744 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions, 5745 CandidateSet); 5746 5747 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set. 5748 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 5749 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) { 5750 case OR_Success: { 5751 // Apply this conversion. 5752 DeclAccessPair Found = 5753 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 5754 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5755 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 5756 return ExprError(); 5757 break; 5758 } 5759 case OR_Ambiguous: 5760 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5761 ViableConversions); 5762 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 5763 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5764 HadMultipleCandidates, 5765 ExplicitConversions)) 5766 return ExprError(); 5767 // fall through 'OR_Deleted' case. 5768 case OR_Deleted: 5769 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 5770 break; 5771 } 5772 } else { 5773 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 5774 case 0: { 5775 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5776 HadMultipleCandidates, 5777 ExplicitConversions)) 5778 return ExprError(); 5779 5780 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 5781 break; 5782 } 5783 case 1: { 5784 // Apply this conversion. 5785 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 5786 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5787 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 5788 return ExprError(); 5789 break; 5790 } 5791 default: 5792 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5793 ViableConversions); 5794 } 5795 } 5796 5797 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 5798 } 5799 5800 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is 5801 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose 5802 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine 5803 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning 5804 /// enumeration types. 5805 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context, 5806 FunctionDecl *Fn, 5807 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 5808 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 5809 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType(); 5810 5811 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType())) 5812 return true; 5813 5814 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType())) 5815 return true; 5816 5817 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5818 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1) 5819 return false; 5820 5821 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) { 5822 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType(); 5823 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType)) 5824 return true; 5825 } 5826 5827 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2) 5828 return false; 5829 5830 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) { 5831 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType(); 5832 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType)) 5833 return true; 5834 } 5835 5836 return false; 5837 } 5838 5839 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 5840 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 5841 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 5842 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 5843 /// 5844 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 5845 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 5846 /// code completion. 5847 void 5848 Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function, 5849 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5850 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5851 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 5852 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5853 bool PartialOverloading, 5854 bool AllowExplicit, 5855 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions) { 5856 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 5857 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 5858 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 5859 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 5860 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 5861 5862 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 5863 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 5864 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 5865 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 5866 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 5867 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 5868 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 5869 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 5870 // is irrelevant. 5871 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(), 5872 Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args, 5873 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 5874 PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions); 5875 return; 5876 } 5877 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 5878 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 5879 } 5880 5881 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function)) 5882 return; 5883 5884 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 5885 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the 5886 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to 5887 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there 5888 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to 5889 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are 5890 // candidate functions. 5891 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 5892 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args)) 5893 return; 5894 5895 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402] 5896 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by 5897 // overload resolution. 5898 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function); 5899 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() && 5900 Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) 5901 return; 5902 5903 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 5904 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 5905 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 5906 5907 // Add this candidate 5908 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 5909 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions); 5910 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5911 Candidate.Function = Function; 5912 Candidate.Viable = true; 5913 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5914 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5915 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 5916 5917 if (Constructor) { 5918 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 5919 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 5920 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 5921 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 5922 if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 5923 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 5924 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getLocStart(), Args[0]->getType(), 5925 ClassType))) { 5926 Candidate.Viable = false; 5927 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor; 5928 return; 5929 } 5930 5931 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution) 5932 // A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter 5933 // of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated 5934 // from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when 5935 // constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly 5936 // one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related 5937 // to C. 5938 auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl()); 5939 if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 && 5940 Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 5941 QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType(); 5942 QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent()); 5943 QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent()); 5944 SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc(); 5945 if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) && 5946 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) { 5947 Candidate.Viable = false; 5948 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice; 5949 return; 5950 } 5951 } 5952 } 5953 5954 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 5955 5956 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 5957 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 5958 // list (8.3.5). 5959 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 5960 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 5961 Candidate.Viable = false; 5962 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 5963 return; 5964 } 5965 5966 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 5967 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 5968 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 5969 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 5970 // exactly m parameters. 5971 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 5972 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 5973 // Not enough arguments. 5974 Candidate.Viable = false; 5975 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 5976 return; 5977 } 5978 5979 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 5980 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 5981 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 5982 // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this 5983 // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is 5984 // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of 5985 // the class. 5986 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) { 5987 Candidate.Viable = false; 5988 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 5989 return; 5990 } 5991 5992 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 5993 // arguments. 5994 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 5995 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isInitialized()) { 5996 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 5997 // template argument deduction. 5998 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 5999 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6000 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6001 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6002 // parameter of F. 6003 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6004 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 6005 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6006 SuppressUserConversions, 6007 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6008 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6009 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6010 AllowExplicit); 6011 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 6012 Candidate.Viable = false; 6013 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6014 return; 6015 } 6016 } else { 6017 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6018 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6019 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6020 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis(); 6021 } 6022 } 6023 6024 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) { 6025 Candidate.Viable = false; 6026 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6027 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6028 return; 6029 } 6030 6031 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) { 6032 Candidate.Viable = false; 6033 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled; 6034 return; 6035 } 6036 } 6037 6038 ObjCMethodDecl * 6039 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance, 6040 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) { 6041 if (Methods.size() <= 1) 6042 return nullptr; 6043 6044 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6045 bool Match = true; 6046 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b]; 6047 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs(); 6048 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due 6049 // to addition of c-style arguments in method. 6050 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs) 6051 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size(); 6052 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs) 6053 continue; 6054 6055 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) { 6056 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument. 6057 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6058 Match = false; 6059 break; 6060 } 6061 6062 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i]; 6063 Expr *argExpr = Args[i]; 6064 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression"); 6065 6066 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's 6067 // a consumed argument. 6068 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) && 6069 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()) 6070 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr); 6071 6072 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method. 6073 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 6074 Match = false; 6075 break; 6076 } 6077 6078 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState 6079 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(), 6080 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false, 6081 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6082 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6083 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6084 /*AllowExplicit*/false); 6085 // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider 6086 // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here. 6087 if (ConversionState.isBad() || 6088 (ConversionState.isStandard() && 6089 ConversionState.Standard.Second == 6090 ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) { 6091 Match = false; 6092 break; 6093 } 6094 } 6095 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods. 6096 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) { 6097 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) { 6098 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6099 Match = false; 6100 break; 6101 } 6102 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 6103 nullptr); 6104 if (Arg.isInvalid()) { 6105 Match = false; 6106 break; 6107 } 6108 } 6109 } else { 6110 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods. 6111 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs) 6112 Match = false; 6113 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) { 6114 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select 6115 // one with the most general result type of 'id'. 6116 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6117 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType(); 6118 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType()) 6119 return Methods[b]; 6120 } 6121 } 6122 } 6123 6124 if (Match) 6125 return Method; 6126 } 6127 return nullptr; 6128 } 6129 6130 // specific_attr_iterator iterates over enable_if attributes in reverse, and 6131 // enable_if is order-sensitive. As a result, we need to reverse things 6132 // sometimes. Size of 4 elements is arbitrary. 6133 static SmallVector<EnableIfAttr *, 4> 6134 getOrderedEnableIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function) { 6135 SmallVector<EnableIfAttr *, 4> Result; 6136 if (!Function->hasAttrs()) 6137 return Result; 6138 6139 const auto &FuncAttrs = Function->getAttrs(); 6140 for (Attr *Attr : FuncAttrs) 6141 if (auto *EnableIf = dyn_cast<EnableIfAttr>(Attr)) 6142 Result.push_back(EnableIf); 6143 6144 std::reverse(Result.begin(), Result.end()); 6145 return Result; 6146 } 6147 6148 static bool 6149 convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, 6150 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, 6151 bool MissingImplicitThis, Expr *&ConvertedThis, 6152 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) { 6153 if (ThisArg) { 6154 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function); 6155 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6156 "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!"); 6157 assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!"); 6158 ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization( 6159 ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method); 6160 if (R.isInvalid()) 6161 return false; 6162 ConvertedThis = R.get(); 6163 } else { 6164 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6165 (void)MD; 6166 assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() || 6167 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) && 6168 "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods"); 6169 } 6170 ConvertedThis = nullptr; 6171 } 6172 6173 // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the 6174 // user can't refer to them in the function condition. 6175 unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size()); 6176 6177 // Convert the arguments. 6178 for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) { 6179 ExprResult R; 6180 R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6181 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)), 6182 SourceLocation(), Args[I]); 6183 6184 if (R.isInvalid()) 6185 return false; 6186 6187 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6188 } 6189 6190 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6191 return false; 6192 6193 // Push default arguments if needed. 6194 if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) { 6195 for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 6196 ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i); 6197 ExprResult R = S.PerformCopyInitialization( 6198 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, 6199 Function->getParamDecl(i)), 6200 SourceLocation(), 6201 P->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg() ? P->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg() 6202 : P->getDefaultArg()); 6203 if (R.isInvalid()) 6204 return false; 6205 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6206 } 6207 6208 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6209 return false; 6210 } 6211 return true; 6212 } 6213 6214 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6215 bool MissingImplicitThis) { 6216 SmallVector<EnableIfAttr *, 4> EnableIfAttrs = 6217 getOrderedEnableIfAttrs(Function); 6218 if (EnableIfAttrs.empty()) 6219 return nullptr; 6220 6221 SFINAETrap Trap(*this); 6222 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs; 6223 // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed. 6224 Expr *DiscardedThis; 6225 if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6226 *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, Args, Trap, 6227 /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs)) 6228 return EnableIfAttrs[0]; 6229 6230 for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) { 6231 APValue Result; 6232 // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is 6233 // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully. 6234 if (!EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6235 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) 6236 return EIA; 6237 6238 if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) 6239 return EIA; 6240 } 6241 return nullptr; 6242 } 6243 6244 template <typename CheckFn> 6245 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND, 6246 bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc, 6247 CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) { 6248 SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs; 6249 for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) { 6250 if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent()) 6251 Attrs.push_back(DIA); 6252 } 6253 6254 // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early. 6255 if (Attrs.empty()) 6256 return false; 6257 6258 auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition( 6259 Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(), 6260 [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); }); 6261 6262 // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the 6263 // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes). 6264 auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin), 6265 IsSuccessful); 6266 if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) { 6267 const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr; 6268 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6269 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6270 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6271 return true; 6272 } 6273 6274 for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end())) 6275 if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) { 6276 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6277 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6278 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6279 } 6280 6281 return false; 6282 } 6283 6284 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function, 6285 const Expr *ThisArg, 6286 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, 6287 SourceLocation Loc) { 6288 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6289 *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc, 6290 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6291 APValue Result; 6292 // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since 6293 // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each 6294 // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to. 6295 if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6296 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg)) 6297 return false; 6298 return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue(); 6299 }); 6300 } 6301 6302 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND, 6303 SourceLocation Loc) { 6304 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6305 *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc, 6306 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6307 bool Result; 6308 return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) && 6309 Result; 6310 }); 6311 } 6312 6313 /// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 6314 /// the overload candidate set. 6315 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 6316 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6317 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6318 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6319 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6320 bool PartialOverloading) { 6321 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 6322 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6323 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 6324 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) { 6325 QualType ObjectType; 6326 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification; 6327 if (Expr *E = Args[0]) { 6328 // Use the explit base to restrict the lookup: 6329 ObjectType = E->getType(); 6330 ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context); 6331 } // .. else there is an implit base. 6332 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 6333 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType, 6334 ObjectClassification, Args.slice(1), CandidateSet, 6335 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6336 } else { 6337 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet, 6338 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6339 } 6340 } else { 6341 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6342 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6343 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic()) { 6344 QualType ObjectType; 6345 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification; 6346 if (Expr *E = Args[0]) { 6347 // Use the explit base to restrict the lookup: 6348 ObjectType = E->getType(); 6349 ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context); 6350 } // .. else there is an implit base. 6351 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6352 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6353 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 6354 ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6355 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6356 PartialOverloading); 6357 } else { 6358 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6359 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 6360 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6361 PartialOverloading); 6362 } 6363 } 6364 } 6365 } 6366 6367 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 6368 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 6369 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6370 QualType ObjectType, 6371 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6372 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6373 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6374 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 6375 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6376 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 6377 6378 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 6379 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 6380 6381 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 6382 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6383 "Expected a member function template"); 6384 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6385 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType, 6386 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6387 SuppressUserConversions); 6388 } else { 6389 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6390 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6391 SuppressUserConversions); 6392 } 6393 } 6394 6395 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 6396 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 6397 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 6398 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 6399 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 6400 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 6401 /// operators. 6402 void 6403 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6404 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6405 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6406 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6407 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6408 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6409 bool PartialOverloading, 6410 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions) { 6411 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6412 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6413 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6414 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6415 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 6416 6417 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method)) 6418 return; 6419 6420 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402] 6421 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is 6422 // ignored by overload resolution. 6423 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() && 6424 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 6425 return; 6426 6427 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6428 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6429 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6430 6431 // Add this candidate 6432 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6433 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions); 6434 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6435 Candidate.Function = Method; 6436 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6437 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6438 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6439 6440 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6441 6442 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6443 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6444 // list (8.3.5). 6445 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6446 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6447 Candidate.Viable = false; 6448 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6449 return; 6450 } 6451 6452 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6453 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6454 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6455 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6456 // exactly m parameters. 6457 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6458 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6459 // Not enough arguments. 6460 Candidate.Viable = false; 6461 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6462 return; 6463 } 6464 6465 Candidate.Viable = true; 6466 6467 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 6468 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 6469 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 6470 else { 6471 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 6472 // parameter. 6473 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6474 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6475 Method, ActingContext); 6476 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 6477 Candidate.Viable = false; 6478 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6479 return; 6480 } 6481 } 6482 6483 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6484 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6485 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6486 if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) { 6487 Candidate.Viable = false; 6488 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6489 return; 6490 } 6491 6492 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6493 // arguments. 6494 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6495 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isInitialized()) { 6496 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6497 // template argument deduction. 6498 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6499 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6500 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6501 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6502 // parameter of F. 6503 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6504 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 6505 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6506 SuppressUserConversions, 6507 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6508 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6509 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6510 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 6511 Candidate.Viable = false; 6512 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6513 return; 6514 } 6515 } else { 6516 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6517 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6518 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6519 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 6520 } 6521 } 6522 6523 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) { 6524 Candidate.Viable = false; 6525 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6526 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6527 return; 6528 } 6529 } 6530 6531 /// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 6532 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 6533 /// function template specialization. 6534 void 6535 Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, 6536 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6537 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6538 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6539 QualType ObjectType, 6540 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6541 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6542 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6543 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6544 bool PartialOverloading) { 6545 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl)) 6546 return; 6547 6548 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6549 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6550 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6551 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6552 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6553 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6554 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6555 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6556 // functions. 6557 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6558 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6559 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 6560 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 6561 MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 6562 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 6563 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 6564 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 6565 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType, 6566 ObjectClassification); 6567 })) { 6568 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6569 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 6570 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6571 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 6572 Candidate.Viable = false; 6573 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6574 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 6575 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() || 6576 ObjectType.isNull(); 6577 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6578 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 6579 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6580 else { 6581 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6582 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6583 Info); 6584 } 6585 return; 6586 } 6587 6588 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 6589 // deduction as a candidate. 6590 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 6591 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 6592 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 6593 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 6594 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 6595 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 6596 Conversions); 6597 } 6598 6599 /// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 6600 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 6601 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 6602 void 6603 Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 6604 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6605 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6606 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6607 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6608 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6609 bool PartialOverloading) { 6610 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 6611 return; 6612 6613 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6614 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6615 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6616 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6617 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6618 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6619 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6620 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6621 // functions. 6622 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6623 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6624 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 6625 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 6626 FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 6627 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 6628 return CheckNonDependentConversions(FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, 6629 Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 6630 SuppressUserConversions); 6631 })) { 6632 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6633 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 6634 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6635 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6636 Candidate.Viable = false; 6637 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6638 // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object 6639 // type. 6640 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 6641 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) && 6642 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function); 6643 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6644 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 6645 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6646 else { 6647 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6648 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6649 Info); 6650 } 6651 return; 6652 } 6653 6654 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 6655 // deduction as a candidate. 6656 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 6657 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 6658 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 6659 /*AllowExplicit*/false, Conversions); 6660 } 6661 6662 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument 6663 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's 6664 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10. 6665 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions( 6666 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes, 6667 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6668 ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6669 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6670 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification) { 6671 // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor 6672 // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear 6673 // that is correct. 6674 const bool AllowExplicit = false; 6675 6676 auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6677 auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6678 bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method); 6679 unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0; 6680 6681 Conversions = 6682 CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size()); 6683 6684 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6685 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6686 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6687 6688 // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't 6689 // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and 6690 // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations. 6691 if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() && 6692 !ObjectType.isNull()) { 6693 Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6694 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6695 Method, ActingContext); 6696 if (Conversions[0].isBad()) 6697 return true; 6698 } 6699 6700 for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N; 6701 ++I) { 6702 QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I]; 6703 if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) { 6704 Conversions[ThisConversions + I] 6705 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType, 6706 SuppressUserConversions, 6707 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6708 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6709 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6710 AllowExplicit); 6711 if (Conversions[ThisConversions + I].isBad()) 6712 return true; 6713 } 6714 } 6715 6716 return false; 6717 } 6718 6719 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result 6720 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++ 6721 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1. 6722 /// 6723 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function. 6724 /// 6725 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to. 6726 /// 6727 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one 6728 /// Objective-C pointer to another. 6729 /// 6730 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise. 6731 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S, 6732 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType, 6733 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) { 6734 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 6735 6736 // Easy case: the types are the same. 6737 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType)) 6738 return true; 6739 6740 // Allow qualification conversions. 6741 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 6742 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false, 6743 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 6744 return true; 6745 6746 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions, 6747 // we're done. 6748 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion) 6749 return false; 6750 6751 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion? 6752 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 6753 QualType ConvertedType; 6754 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType, 6755 IncompatibleObjC); 6756 } 6757 6758 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 6759 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 6760 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 6761 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 6762 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 6763 /// conversion function produces). 6764 void 6765 Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 6766 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6767 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6768 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 6769 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6770 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 6771 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 6772 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 6773 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6774 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 6775 return; 6776 6777 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its 6778 // deduction now. 6779 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) { 6780 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc())) 6781 return; 6782 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6783 } 6784 6785 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion 6786 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or 6787 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion. 6788 if (Conversion->isExplicit() && 6789 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType, 6790 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) 6791 return; 6792 6793 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6794 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6795 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6796 6797 // Add this candidate 6798 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 6799 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6800 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 6801 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6802 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6803 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 6804 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 6805 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 6806 Candidate.Viable = true; 6807 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 6808 6809 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 6810 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 6811 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 6812 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 6813 // 6814 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 6815 // object parameter. 6816 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 6817 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 6818 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 6819 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 6820 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 6821 6822 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6823 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(), 6824 From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext); 6825 6826 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 6827 Candidate.Viable = false; 6828 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6829 return; 6830 } 6831 6832 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a 6833 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 6834 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 6835 QualType FromCanon 6836 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 6837 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6838 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || 6839 IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 6840 Candidate.Viable = false; 6841 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 6842 return; 6843 } 6844 6845 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 6846 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 6847 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 6848 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 6849 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 6850 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 6851 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 6852 // well-formed. 6853 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 6854 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart()); 6855 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 6856 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 6857 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, 6858 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue); 6859 6860 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 6861 if (!isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType)) { 6862 Candidate.Viable = false; 6863 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6864 return; 6865 } 6866 6867 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 6868 6869 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 6870 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 6871 // allocator). 6872 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 6873 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK, 6874 From->getLocStart()); 6875 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 6876 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType, 6877 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 6878 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 6879 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 6880 6881 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 6882 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 6883 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 6884 6885 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 6886 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 6887 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 6888 // shall have exact match rank. 6889 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 6890 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 6891 Candidate.Viable = false; 6892 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 6893 return; 6894 } 6895 6896 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 6897 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 6898 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 6899 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 6900 // program is ill-formed. 6901 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 6902 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 6903 Candidate.Viable = false; 6904 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6905 return; 6906 } 6907 break; 6908 6909 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 6910 Candidate.Viable = false; 6911 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6912 return; 6913 6914 default: 6915 llvm_unreachable( 6916 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 6917 } 6918 6919 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) { 6920 Candidate.Viable = false; 6921 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6922 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6923 return; 6924 } 6925 } 6926 6927 /// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization 6928 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 6929 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 6930 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 6931 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 6932 void 6933 Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 6934 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6935 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, 6936 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 6937 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6938 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 6939 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6940 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 6941 6942 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 6943 return; 6944 6945 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6946 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6947 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 6948 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 6949 Specialization, Info)) { 6950 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 6951 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6952 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6953 Candidate.Viable = false; 6954 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6955 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6956 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6957 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 6958 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6959 Info); 6960 return; 6961 } 6962 6963 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 6964 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 6965 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 6966 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 6967 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 6968 } 6969 6970 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 6971 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 6972 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 6973 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 6974 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 6975 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 6976 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6977 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6978 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 6979 Expr *Object, 6980 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6981 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 6982 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 6983 return; 6984 6985 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6986 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6987 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6988 6989 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 6990 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6991 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 6992 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 6993 Candidate.Viable = true; 6994 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 6995 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6996 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6997 6998 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 6999 // object parameter. 7000 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7001 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(), 7002 Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext); 7003 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 7004 Candidate.Viable = false; 7005 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7006 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 7007 return; 7008 } 7009 7010 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 7011 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 7012 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 7013 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 7014 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 7015 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 7016 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 7017 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 7018 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 7019 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 7020 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 7021 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7022 7023 // Find the 7024 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 7025 7026 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 7027 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 7028 // list (8.3.5). 7029 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 7030 Candidate.Viable = false; 7031 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 7032 return; 7033 } 7034 7035 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 7036 // we have enough arguments. 7037 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 7038 // Not enough arguments. 7039 Candidate.Viable = false; 7040 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 7041 return; 7042 } 7043 7044 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7045 // arguments. 7046 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7047 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 7048 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 7049 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 7050 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 7051 // parameter of F. 7052 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 7053 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 7054 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 7055 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 7056 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7057 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7058 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7059 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 7060 Candidate.Viable = false; 7061 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7062 return; 7063 } 7064 } else { 7065 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 7066 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 7067 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 7068 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 7069 } 7070 } 7071 7072 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) { 7073 Candidate.Viable = false; 7074 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7075 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7076 return; 7077 } 7078 } 7079 7080 /// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 7081 /// member functions. 7082 /// 7083 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 7084 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 7085 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 7086 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 7087 /// [over.match.oper]). 7088 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 7089 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7090 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7091 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7092 SourceRange OpRange) { 7093 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7094 7095 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7096 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 7097 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 7098 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 7099 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 7100 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 7101 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 7102 // constructed as follows: 7103 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 7104 7105 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being 7106 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the 7107 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, 7108 // the set of member candidates is empty. 7109 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7110 // Complete the type if it can be completed. 7111 if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined()) 7112 return; 7113 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now. 7114 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition()) 7115 return; 7116 7117 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 7118 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 7119 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 7120 7121 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 7122 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 7123 Oper != OperEnd; 7124 ++Oper) 7125 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 7126 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 7127 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 7128 } 7129 } 7130 7131 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 7132 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 7133 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 7134 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 7135 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 7136 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 7137 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 7138 /// converted to bool. 7139 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7140 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7141 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 7142 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7143 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7144 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7145 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7146 7147 // Add this candidate 7148 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 7149 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none); 7150 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7151 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7152 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7153 std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes); 7154 7155 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7156 // arguments. 7157 Candidate.Viable = true; 7158 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7159 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7160 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 7161 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 7162 // left operand are restricted as follows: 7163 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 7164 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 7165 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 7166 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 7167 // 7168 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 7169 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 7170 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 7171 // is not of the same type. 7172 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7173 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 7174 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 7175 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7176 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 7177 } else { 7178 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7179 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 7180 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 7181 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7182 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7183 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7184 } 7185 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 7186 Candidate.Viable = false; 7187 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7188 break; 7189 } 7190 } 7191 } 7192 7193 namespace { 7194 7195 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 7196 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 7197 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 7198 /// enumeration types. 7199 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 7200 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 7201 typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>, 7202 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet; 7203 7204 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 7205 /// built-in candidates. 7206 TypeSet PointerTypes; 7207 7208 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 7209 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7210 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 7211 7212 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 7213 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7214 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 7215 7216 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 7217 /// candidates. 7218 TypeSet VectorTypes; 7219 7220 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 7221 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 7222 7223 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 7224 /// were present in the candidate set. 7225 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 7226 7227 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 7228 /// candidate set. 7229 bool HasNullPtrType; 7230 7231 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 7232 /// candidate type set. 7233 Sema &SemaRef; 7234 7235 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 7236 ASTContext &Context; 7237 7238 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7239 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 7240 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 7241 7242 public: 7243 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 7244 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 7245 7246 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 7247 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 7248 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 7249 HasNullPtrType(false), 7250 SemaRef(SemaRef), 7251 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 7252 7253 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7254 SourceLocation Loc, 7255 bool AllowUserConversions, 7256 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7257 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 7258 7259 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 7260 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 7261 7262 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 7263 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 7264 7265 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 7266 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 7267 7268 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 7269 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 7270 7271 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 7272 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 7273 7274 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 7275 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 7276 7277 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); } 7278 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); } 7279 7280 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 7281 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 7282 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 7283 }; 7284 7285 } // end anonymous namespace 7286 7287 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 7288 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7289 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7290 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7291 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7292 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7293 /// false otherwise. 7294 /// 7295 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7296 bool 7297 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7298 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7299 7300 // Insert this type. 7301 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7302 return false; 7303 7304 QualType PointeeTy; 7305 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 7306 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 7307 if (!PointerTy) { 7308 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7309 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 7310 buildObjCPtr = true; 7311 } else { 7312 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7313 } 7314 7315 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7316 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7317 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7318 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7319 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7320 return true; 7321 7322 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7323 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 7324 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 7325 7326 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 7327 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7328 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7329 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types. 7330 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 7331 7332 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if 7333 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified. 7334 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && 7335 (!hasRestrict || 7336 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType())))) 7337 continue; 7338 7339 // Build qualified pointee type. 7340 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7341 7342 // Build qualified pointer type. 7343 QualType QPointerTy; 7344 if (!buildObjCPtr) 7345 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7346 else 7347 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7348 7349 // Insert qualified pointer type. 7350 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy); 7351 } 7352 7353 return true; 7354 } 7355 7356 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 7357 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7358 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7359 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7360 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7361 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7362 /// false otherwise. 7363 /// 7364 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7365 bool 7366 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 7367 QualType Ty) { 7368 // Insert this type. 7369 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7370 return false; 7371 7372 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 7373 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 7374 7375 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7376 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7377 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7378 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7379 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7380 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7381 return true; 7382 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 7383 7384 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 7385 // qualifiers. 7386 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7387 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7388 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7389 7390 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7391 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 7392 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 7393 } 7394 7395 return true; 7396 } 7397 7398 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 7399 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 7400 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 7401 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 7402 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 7403 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 7404 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 7405 /// type. 7406 void 7407 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7408 SourceLocation Loc, 7409 bool AllowUserConversions, 7410 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7411 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7412 // Only deal with canonical types. 7413 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 7414 7415 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 7416 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 7417 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7418 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 7419 7420 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 7421 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 7422 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 7423 7424 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 7425 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 7426 7427 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 7428 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 7429 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 7430 7431 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 7432 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 7433 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 7434 7435 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 7436 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 7437 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 7438 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 7439 // of types. 7440 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 7441 return; 7442 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 7443 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 7444 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 7445 return; 7446 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 7447 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7448 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 7449 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 7450 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 7451 // extension. 7452 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7453 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 7454 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 7455 HasNullPtrType = true; 7456 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 7457 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 7458 if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty)) 7459 return; 7460 7461 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 7462 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 7463 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7464 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7465 7466 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 7467 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 7468 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 7469 continue; 7470 7471 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 7472 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 7473 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 7474 VisibleQuals); 7475 } 7476 } 7477 } 7478 } 7479 7480 /// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 7481 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 7482 /// given type to the candidate set. 7483 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 7484 QualType T, 7485 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7486 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 7487 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7488 7489 // T& operator=(T&, T) 7490 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 7491 ParamTypes[1] = T; 7492 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7493 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 7494 7495 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 7496 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 7497 ParamTypes[0] 7498 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T)); 7499 ParamTypes[1] = T; 7500 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7501 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 7502 } 7503 } 7504 7505 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 7506 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 7507 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 7508 Qualifiers VRQuals; 7509 const RecordType *TyRec; 7510 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 7511 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 7512 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7513 else 7514 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7515 if (!TyRec) { 7516 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 7517 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 7518 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 7519 return VRQuals; 7520 } 7521 7522 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 7523 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 7524 return VRQuals; 7525 7526 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 7527 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7528 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7529 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 7530 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 7531 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7532 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 7533 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 7534 // as see them. 7535 bool done = false; 7536 while (!done) { 7537 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 7538 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 7539 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 7540 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 7541 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 7542 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 7543 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 7544 else 7545 done = true; 7546 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 7547 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 7548 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 7549 return VRQuals; 7550 } 7551 } 7552 } 7553 return VRQuals; 7554 } 7555 7556 namespace { 7557 7558 /// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 7559 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 7560 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 7561 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 7562 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 7563 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 7564 Sema &S; 7565 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args; 7566 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 7567 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 7568 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 7569 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 7570 7571 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types 7572 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below. 7573 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 7574 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 7575 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 4; 7576 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 21; 7577 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 4, 7578 LastPromotedIntegralType = 12; 7579 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0, 7580 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 12; 7581 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 21; 7582 7583 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index. 7584 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) { 7585 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes); 7586 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const 7587 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = { 7588 // Start of promoted types. 7589 &ASTContext::FloatTy, 7590 &ASTContext::DoubleTy, 7591 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy, 7592 &ASTContext::Float128Ty, 7593 7594 // Start of integral types. 7595 &ASTContext::IntTy, 7596 &ASTContext::LongTy, 7597 &ASTContext::LongLongTy, 7598 &ASTContext::Int128Ty, 7599 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy, 7600 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy, 7601 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy, 7602 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty, 7603 // End of promoted types. 7604 7605 &ASTContext::BoolTy, 7606 &ASTContext::CharTy, 7607 &ASTContext::WCharTy, 7608 &ASTContext::Char16Ty, 7609 &ASTContext::Char32Ty, 7610 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy, 7611 &ASTContext::ShortTy, 7612 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy, 7613 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy, 7614 // End of integral types. 7615 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half? 7616 }; 7617 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index]; 7618 } 7619 7620 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 7621 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 7622 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 7623 bool HasVolatile, 7624 bool HasRestrict) { 7625 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 7626 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 7627 S.Context.IntTy 7628 }; 7629 7630 // Non-volatile version. 7631 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7632 7633 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 7634 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 7635 if (HasVolatile) { 7636 ParamTypes[0] = 7637 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7638 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 7639 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7640 } 7641 7642 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type 7643 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer. 7644 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() && 7645 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) { 7646 ParamTypes[0] 7647 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7648 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict)); 7649 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7650 7651 if (HasVolatile) { 7652 ParamTypes[0] 7653 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7654 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, 7655 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 7656 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 7657 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7658 } 7659 } 7660 7661 } 7662 7663 public: 7664 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 7665 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7666 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 7667 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 7668 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 7669 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 7670 : S(S), Args(Args), 7671 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 7672 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 7673 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 7674 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 7675 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 7676 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds. 7677 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy && 7678 "Invalid first promoted integral type"); 7679 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1) 7680 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty && 7681 "Invalid last promoted integral type"); 7682 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType) 7683 == S.Context.FloatTy && 7684 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type"); 7685 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1) 7686 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty && 7687 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type"); 7688 } 7689 7690 // C++ [over.built]p3: 7691 // 7692 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ 7693 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator 7694 // functions of the form 7695 // 7696 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 7697 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 7698 // 7699 // C++ [over.built]p4: 7700 // 7701 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 7702 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 7703 // candidate operator functions of the form 7704 // 7705 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 7706 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 7707 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 7708 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7709 return; 7710 7711 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1); 7712 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 7713 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 7714 getArithmeticType(Arith), 7715 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(), 7716 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()); 7717 } 7718 } 7719 7720 // C++ [over.built]p5: 7721 // 7722 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 7723 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 7724 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7725 // 7726 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 7727 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 7728 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 7729 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 7730 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 7731 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7732 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7733 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7734 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7735 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 7736 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 7737 continue; 7738 7739 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr, 7740 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 7741 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()), 7742 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 7743 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict())); 7744 } 7745 } 7746 7747 // C++ [over.built]p6: 7748 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 7749 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7750 // 7751 // T& operator*(T*); 7752 // 7753 // C++ [over.built]p7: 7754 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 7755 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7756 // T& operator*(T*); 7757 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 7758 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7759 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7760 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7761 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7762 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 7763 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 7764 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 7765 continue; 7766 7767 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 7768 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 7769 continue; 7770 7771 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7772 } 7773 } 7774 7775 // C++ [over.built]p9: 7776 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 7777 // operator functions of the form 7778 // 7779 // T operator+(T); 7780 // T operator-(T); 7781 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 7782 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7783 return; 7784 7785 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 7786 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 7787 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith); 7788 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7789 } 7790 7791 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 7792 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7793 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7794 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7795 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 7796 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 7797 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7798 } 7799 } 7800 7801 // C++ [over.built]p8: 7802 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 7803 // the form 7804 // 7805 // T* operator+(T*); 7806 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 7807 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7808 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7809 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7810 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7811 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 7812 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7813 } 7814 } 7815 7816 // C++ [over.built]p10: 7817 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 7818 // operator functions of the form 7819 // 7820 // T operator~(T); 7821 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 7822 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7823 return; 7824 7825 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 7826 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 7827 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int); 7828 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7829 } 7830 7831 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 7832 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7833 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7834 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7835 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 7836 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 7837 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7838 } 7839 } 7840 7841 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 7842 // For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there 7843 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7844 // 7845 // bool operator==(T,T); 7846 // bool operator!=(T,T); 7847 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() { 7848 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7849 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7850 7851 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7852 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7853 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 7854 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 7855 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 7856 ++MemPtr) { 7857 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 7858 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 7859 continue; 7860 7861 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 7862 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7863 } 7864 7865 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 7866 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 7867 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) { 7868 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 7869 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7870 } 7871 } 7872 } 7873 } 7874 7875 // C++ [over.built]p15: 7876 // 7877 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type, 7878 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7879 // 7880 // bool operator<(T, T); 7881 // bool operator>(T, T); 7882 // bool operator<=(T, T); 7883 // bool operator>=(T, T); 7884 // bool operator==(T, T); 7885 // bool operator!=(T, T); 7886 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 7887 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7888 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator 7889 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...] 7890 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member 7891 // candidate. 7892 // 7893 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there 7894 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator 7895 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other 7896 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=, 7897 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 7898 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 7899 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 7900 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 7901 7902 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7903 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() != 7904 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 7905 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 7906 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 7907 C != CEnd; ++C) { 7908 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 7909 continue; 7910 7911 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 7912 continue; 7913 7914 QualType FirstParamType = 7915 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7916 QualType SecondParamType = 7917 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 7918 7919 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 7920 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 7921 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 7922 continue; 7923 7924 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 7925 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 7926 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 7927 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 7928 } 7929 } 7930 } 7931 7932 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7933 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7934 7935 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7936 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7937 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 7938 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 7939 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7940 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 7941 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 7942 continue; 7943 7944 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 7945 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7946 } 7947 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7948 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 7949 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 7950 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 7951 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 7952 7953 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 7954 // candidate exists. 7955 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second || 7956 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 7957 CanonType))) 7958 continue; 7959 7960 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 7961 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7962 } 7963 } 7964 } 7965 7966 // C++ [over.built]p13: 7967 // 7968 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 7969 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7970 // 7971 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 7972 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 7973 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 7974 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 7975 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 7976 // 7977 // C++ [over.built]p14: 7978 // 7979 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 7980 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7981 // 7982 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 7983 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 7984 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7985 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7986 7987 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 7988 QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = { 7989 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 7990 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 7991 }; 7992 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7993 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(), 7994 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end(); 7995 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7996 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 7997 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 7998 continue; 7999 8000 AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr; 8001 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 8002 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 8003 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8004 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8005 } 8006 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 8007 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8008 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8009 continue; 8010 8011 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8012 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8013 } 8014 } 8015 } 8016 } 8017 8018 // C++ [over.built]p12: 8019 // 8020 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 8021 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8022 // 8023 // LR operator*(L, R); 8024 // LR operator/(L, R); 8025 // LR operator+(L, R); 8026 // LR operator-(L, R); 8027 // bool operator<(L, R); 8028 // bool operator>(L, R); 8029 // bool operator<=(L, R); 8030 // bool operator>=(L, R); 8031 // bool operator==(L, R); 8032 // bool operator!=(L, R); 8033 // 8034 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8035 // between types L and R. 8036 // 8037 // C++ [over.built]p24: 8038 // 8039 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 8040 // candidate operator functions of the form 8041 // 8042 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 8043 // 8044 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8045 // between types L and R. 8046 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 8047 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8048 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8049 return; 8050 8051 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8052 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 8053 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8054 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8055 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left), 8056 getArithmeticType(Right) }; 8057 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8058 } 8059 } 8060 8061 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 8062 // conditional operator for vector types. 8063 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8064 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 8065 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 8066 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 8067 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8068 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 8069 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 8070 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 8071 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 }; 8072 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8073 } 8074 } 8075 } 8076 8077 // C++ [over.built]p17: 8078 // 8079 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 8080 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8081 // 8082 // LR operator%(L, R); 8083 // LR operator&(L, R); 8084 // LR operator^(L, R); 8085 // LR operator|(L, R); 8086 // L operator<<(L, R); 8087 // L operator>>(L, R); 8088 // 8089 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8090 // between types L and R. 8091 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8092 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8093 return; 8094 8095 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8096 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 8097 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8098 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8099 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left), 8100 getArithmeticType(Right) }; 8101 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8102 } 8103 } 8104 } 8105 8106 // C++ [over.built]p20: 8107 // 8108 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 8109 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 8110 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8111 // 8112 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 8113 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8114 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8115 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8116 8117 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8118 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8119 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8120 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8121 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8122 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 8123 continue; 8124 8125 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet); 8126 } 8127 8128 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8129 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8130 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8131 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8132 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8133 continue; 8134 8135 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet); 8136 } 8137 } 8138 } 8139 8140 // C++ [over.built]p19: 8141 // 8142 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 8143 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 8144 // of the form 8145 // 8146 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 8147 // 8148 // C++ [over.built]p21: 8149 // 8150 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8151 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 8152 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8153 // 8154 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8155 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8156 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8157 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8158 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8159 8160 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8161 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8162 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8163 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8164 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 8165 if (isEqualOp) 8166 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 8167 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8168 continue; 8169 8170 // non-volatile version 8171 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8172 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8173 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8174 }; 8175 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8176 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 8177 8178 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8179 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8180 if (NeedVolatile) { 8181 // volatile version 8182 ParamTypes[0] = 8183 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8184 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8185 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8186 } 8187 8188 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8189 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8190 // restrict version 8191 ParamTypes[0] 8192 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8193 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8194 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8195 8196 if (NeedVolatile) { 8197 // volatile restrict version 8198 ParamTypes[0] 8199 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8200 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8201 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8202 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8203 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8204 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8205 } 8206 } 8207 } 8208 8209 if (isEqualOp) { 8210 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8211 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8212 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8213 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8214 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 8215 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8216 continue; 8217 8218 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8219 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8220 *Ptr, 8221 }; 8222 8223 // non-volatile version 8224 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8225 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 8226 8227 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8228 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8229 if (NeedVolatile) { 8230 // volatile version 8231 ParamTypes[0] = 8232 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8233 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8234 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 8235 } 8236 8237 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8238 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8239 // restrict version 8240 ParamTypes[0] 8241 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8242 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8243 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 8244 8245 if (NeedVolatile) { 8246 // volatile restrict version 8247 ParamTypes[0] 8248 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8249 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8250 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8251 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8252 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8253 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 8254 } 8255 } 8256 } 8257 } 8258 } 8259 8260 // C++ [over.built]p18: 8261 // 8262 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 8263 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 8264 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 8265 // the form 8266 // 8267 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 8268 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 8269 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 8270 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 8271 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 8272 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8273 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8274 return; 8275 8276 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 8277 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8278 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8279 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8280 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right); 8281 8282 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8283 ParamTypes[0] = 8284 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 8285 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8286 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8287 8288 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8289 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8290 ParamTypes[0] = 8291 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 8292 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8293 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8294 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8295 } 8296 } 8297 } 8298 8299 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 8300 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8301 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 8302 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 8303 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 8304 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8305 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 8306 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 8307 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 8308 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8309 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2; 8310 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8311 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1); 8312 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8313 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8314 8315 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8316 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8317 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1); 8318 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8319 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8320 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8321 } 8322 } 8323 } 8324 } 8325 8326 // C++ [over.built]p22: 8327 // 8328 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 8329 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 8330 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8331 // 8332 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 8333 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 8334 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 8335 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 8336 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 8337 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 8338 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 8339 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8340 return; 8341 8342 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 8343 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8344 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8345 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8346 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right); 8347 8348 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8349 ParamTypes[0] = 8350 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left)); 8351 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8352 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8353 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8354 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left); 8355 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 8356 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8357 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8358 } 8359 } 8360 } 8361 } 8362 8363 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 8364 // 8365 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 8366 // 8367 // bool operator!(bool); 8368 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 8369 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 8370 void addExclaimOverload() { 8371 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 8372 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet, 8373 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8374 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 8375 } 8376 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 8377 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 8378 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8379 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8380 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 8381 } 8382 8383 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8384 // 8385 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 8386 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8387 // 8388 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8389 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 8390 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8391 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 8392 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 8393 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 8394 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8395 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8396 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8397 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8398 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 8399 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8400 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8401 continue; 8402 8403 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 8404 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8405 } 8406 8407 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8408 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8409 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8410 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8411 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 8412 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8413 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8414 continue; 8415 8416 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 8417 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8418 } 8419 } 8420 8421 // C++ [over.built]p11: 8422 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 8423 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 8424 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 8425 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8426 // 8427 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 8428 // 8429 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 8430 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 8431 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8432 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8433 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8434 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8435 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 8436 QualType C1; 8437 QualifierCollector Q1; 8438 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 8439 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 8440 continue; 8441 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 8442 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 8443 // volatile/restrict type. 8444 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 8445 continue; 8446 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 8447 continue; 8448 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8449 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 8450 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 8451 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8452 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 8453 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 8454 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 8455 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2)) 8456 break; 8457 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 8458 // build CV12 T& 8459 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 8460 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 8461 T.isVolatileQualified()) 8462 continue; 8463 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 8464 T.isRestrictQualified()) 8465 continue; 8466 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 8467 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8468 } 8469 } 8470 } 8471 8472 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 8473 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 8474 // therefore added as binary. 8475 // 8476 // C++ [over.built]p25: 8477 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 8478 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8479 // 8480 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 8481 // 8482 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 8483 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8484 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8485 8486 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8487 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8488 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 8489 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 8490 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8491 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8492 continue; 8493 8494 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8495 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8496 } 8497 8498 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8499 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8500 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8501 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8502 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8503 continue; 8504 8505 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 8506 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8507 } 8508 8509 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 8510 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8511 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8512 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8513 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8514 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 8515 continue; 8516 8517 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 8518 continue; 8519 8520 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 8521 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8522 } 8523 } 8524 } 8525 } 8526 }; 8527 8528 } // end anonymous namespace 8529 8530 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 8531 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 8532 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 8533 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 8534 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 8535 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 8536 SourceLocation OpLoc, 8537 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8538 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 8539 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 8540 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 8541 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 8542 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 8543 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 8544 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 8545 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 8546 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 8547 8548 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 8549 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 8550 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 8551 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8552 CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this); 8553 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 8554 OpLoc, 8555 true, 8556 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 8557 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 8558 Op == OO_PipePipe), 8559 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 8560 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 8561 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 8562 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 8563 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 8564 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 8565 } 8566 8567 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 8568 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 8569 // 8570 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 8571 // 'bool' overloads. 8572 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 8573 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 8574 return; 8575 8576 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 8577 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, 8578 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 8579 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 8580 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 8581 8582 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 8583 switch (Op) { 8584 case OO_None: 8585 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 8586 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 8587 8588 case OO_New: 8589 case OO_Delete: 8590 case OO_Array_New: 8591 case OO_Array_Delete: 8592 case OO_Call: 8593 llvm_unreachable( 8594 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 8595 8596 case OO_Comma: 8597 case OO_Arrow: 8598 case OO_Coawait: 8599 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8600 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the 8601 // operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the 8602 // built-in candidates set is empty. 8603 break; 8604 8605 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 8606 if (Args.size() == 1) 8607 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 8608 // Fall through. 8609 8610 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 8611 if (Args.size() == 1) { 8612 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 8613 } else { 8614 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 8615 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8616 } 8617 break; 8618 8619 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 8620 if (Args.size() == 1) 8621 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 8622 else 8623 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8624 break; 8625 8626 case OO_Slash: 8627 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8628 break; 8629 8630 case OO_PlusPlus: 8631 case OO_MinusMinus: 8632 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8633 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 8634 break; 8635 8636 case OO_EqualEqual: 8637 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 8638 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads(); 8639 // Fall through. 8640 8641 case OO_Less: 8642 case OO_Greater: 8643 case OO_LessEqual: 8644 case OO_GreaterEqual: 8645 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 8646 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8647 break; 8648 8649 case OO_Percent: 8650 case OO_Caret: 8651 case OO_Pipe: 8652 case OO_LessLess: 8653 case OO_GreaterGreater: 8654 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8655 break; 8656 8657 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 8658 if (Args.size() == 1) 8659 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8660 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 8661 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 8662 break; 8663 8664 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8665 break; 8666 8667 case OO_Tilde: 8668 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 8669 break; 8670 8671 case OO_Equal: 8672 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 8673 // Fall through. 8674 8675 case OO_PlusEqual: 8676 case OO_MinusEqual: 8677 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 8678 // Fall through. 8679 8680 case OO_StarEqual: 8681 case OO_SlashEqual: 8682 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 8683 break; 8684 8685 case OO_PercentEqual: 8686 case OO_LessLessEqual: 8687 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 8688 case OO_AmpEqual: 8689 case OO_CaretEqual: 8690 case OO_PipeEqual: 8691 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 8692 break; 8693 8694 case OO_Exclaim: 8695 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 8696 break; 8697 8698 case OO_AmpAmp: 8699 case OO_PipePipe: 8700 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 8701 break; 8702 8703 case OO_Subscript: 8704 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 8705 break; 8706 8707 case OO_ArrowStar: 8708 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 8709 break; 8710 8711 case OO_Conditional: 8712 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 8713 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8714 break; 8715 } 8716 } 8717 8718 /// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 8719 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 8720 /// 8721 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 8722 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 8723 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 8724 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 8725 void 8726 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 8727 SourceLocation Loc, 8728 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8729 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 8730 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 8731 bool PartialOverloading) { 8732 ADLResult Fns; 8733 8734 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 8735 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 8736 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 8737 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 8738 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 8739 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 8740 8741 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 8742 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns); 8743 8744 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 8745 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 8746 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 8747 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 8748 if (Cand->Function) { 8749 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 8750 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 8751 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 8752 } 8753 8754 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 8755 // set. 8756 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 8757 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 8758 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 8759 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 8760 continue; 8761 8762 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false, 8763 PartialOverloading); 8764 } else 8765 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I), 8766 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 8767 Args, CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 8768 } 8769 } 8770 8771 namespace { 8772 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse }; 8773 } 8774 8775 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of 8776 /// overload resolution. 8777 /// 8778 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff 8779 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as 8780 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if 8781 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes. 8782 /// 8783 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if 8784 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are 8785 /// worse than Cand1's. 8786 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1, 8787 const FunctionDecl *Cand2) { 8788 // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs. 8789 bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 8790 bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 8791 if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) { 8792 if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr) 8793 return Comparison::Equal; 8794 return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse; 8795 } 8796 8797 // FIXME: The next several lines are just 8798 // specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> but going in declaration order, 8799 // instead of reverse order which is how they're stored in the AST. 8800 auto Cand1Attrs = getOrderedEnableIfAttrs(Cand1); 8801 auto Cand2Attrs = getOrderedEnableIfAttrs(Cand2); 8802 8803 // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1 8804 // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2. 8805 if (Cand1Attrs.size() < Cand2Attrs.size()) 8806 return Comparison::Worse; 8807 8808 auto Cand1I = Cand1Attrs.begin(); 8809 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID; 8810 for (auto &Cand2A : Cand2Attrs) { 8811 Cand1ID.clear(); 8812 Cand2ID.clear(); 8813 8814 auto &Cand1A = *Cand1I++; 8815 Cand1A->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 8816 Cand2A->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 8817 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID) 8818 return Comparison::Worse; 8819 } 8820 8821 return Cand1I == Cand1Attrs.end() ? Comparison::Equal : Comparison::Better; 8822 } 8823 8824 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 8825 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 8826 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 8827 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 8828 SourceLocation Loc, 8829 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 8830 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 8831 // functions. 8832 if (!Cand2.Viable) 8833 return Cand1.Viable; 8834 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 8835 return false; 8836 8837 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 8838 // 8839 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 8840 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 8841 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 8842 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 8843 unsigned StartArg = 0; 8844 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 8845 StartArg = 1; 8846 8847 auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 8848 // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++. 8849 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8850 return ICS.isStandard() && 8851 ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 8852 8853 // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to 8854 // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11. 8855 return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 8856 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS); 8857 }; 8858 8859 // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given 8860 // argument to be better candidates than functions that do. 8861 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size(); 8862 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 8863 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 8864 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 8865 bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 8866 bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 8867 if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) { 8868 if (Cand1Bad) 8869 return false; 8870 HasBetterConversion = true; 8871 } 8872 } 8873 8874 if (HasBetterConversion) 8875 return true; 8876 8877 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 8878 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 8879 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 8880 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 8881 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 8882 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 8883 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 8884 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 8885 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 8886 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 8887 HasBetterConversion = true; 8888 break; 8889 8890 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 8891 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 8892 return false; 8893 8894 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 8895 // Do nothing. 8896 break; 8897 } 8898 } 8899 8900 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 8901 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 8902 if (HasBetterConversion) 8903 return true; 8904 8905 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 8906 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 8907 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 8908 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 8909 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 8910 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 8911 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 8912 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 8913 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 8914 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 8915 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 8916 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 8917 // pointer or block. 8918 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 8919 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 8920 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 8921 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 8922 Cand1.FinalConversion, 8923 Cand2.FinalConversion); 8924 8925 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 8926 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 8927 8928 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions 8929 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per 8930 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3. 8931 } 8932 8933 // -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not 8934 auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function); 8935 auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function); 8936 if (Guide1 && Guide2 && Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit()) 8937 return Guide2->isImplicit(); 8938 8939 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 8940 // specialization, or, if not that, 8941 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function && 8942 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 8943 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function && 8944 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 8945 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization) 8946 return Cand2IsSpecialization; 8947 8948 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 8949 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 8950 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 8951 // if not that, 8952 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) { 8953 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate 8954 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 8955 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 8956 Loc, 8957 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion 8958 : TPOC_Call, 8959 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, 8960 Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments)) 8961 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 8962 } 8963 8964 // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 inheriting constructor wording. 8965 // A derived-class constructor beats an (inherited) base class constructor. 8966 bool Cand1IsInherited = 8967 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 8968 bool Cand2IsInherited = 8969 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 8970 if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited) 8971 return Cand2IsInherited; 8972 else if (Cand1IsInherited) { 8973 assert(Cand2IsInherited); 8974 auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext()); 8975 auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext()); 8976 if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class)) 8977 return true; 8978 if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class)) 8979 return false; 8980 // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous. 8981 } 8982 8983 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution. 8984 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 8985 Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 8986 if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal) 8987 return Cmp == Comparison::Better; 8988 } 8989 8990 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 8991 FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 8992 return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) > 8993 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 8994 } 8995 8996 bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr && 8997 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function); 8998 bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr && 8999 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function); 9000 return HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1; 9001 } 9002 9003 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of 9004 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no 9005 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including 9006 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to 9007 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both 9008 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using 9009 /// a modularized libstdc++). 9010 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A, 9011 const NamedDecl *B) { 9012 auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A); 9013 auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B); 9014 if (!VA || !VB) 9015 return false; 9016 9017 // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage 9018 // entity in different modules. 9019 if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 9020 VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) || 9021 getOwningModule(const_cast<ValueDecl *>(VA)) == 9022 getOwningModule(const_cast<ValueDecl *>(VB)) || 9023 VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible()) 9024 return false; 9025 9026 // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent. 9027 // 9028 // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity. 9029 // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is 9030 // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all. 9031 if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType())) 9032 return true; 9033 9034 // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but 9035 // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes. 9036 if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) { 9037 if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) { 9038 // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and 9039 // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type. 9040 auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext()); 9041 auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext()); 9042 if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() || 9043 !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(), 9044 EnumB->getIntegerType())) 9045 return false; 9046 // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators. 9047 return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal()); 9048 } 9049 } 9050 9051 // Nothing else is sufficiently similar. 9052 return false; 9053 } 9054 9055 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations( 9056 SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) { 9057 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D; 9058 9059 Module *M = getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl*>(D)); 9060 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9061 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9062 9063 for (auto *E : Equiv) { 9064 Module *M = getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl*>(E)); 9065 Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9066 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9067 } 9068 } 9069 9070 /// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 9071 /// within an overload candidate set. 9072 /// 9073 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 9074 /// which overload resolution occurs. 9075 /// 9076 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 9077 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found. 9078 /// 9079 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 9080 OverloadingResult 9081 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9082 iterator &Best, 9083 bool UserDefinedConversion) { 9084 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates; 9085 std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates), 9086 [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; }); 9087 9088 // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but 9089 // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular 9090 // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to 9091 // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based 9092 // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one 9093 // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore 9094 // the WrongSide candidate. 9095 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) { 9096 const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9097 bool ContainsSameSideCandidate = 9098 llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9099 return Cand->Function && 9100 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9101 Sema::CFP_SameSide; 9102 }); 9103 if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) { 9104 auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9105 return Cand->Function && 9106 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9107 Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9108 }; 9109 llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate); 9110 } 9111 } 9112 9113 // Find the best viable function. 9114 Best = end(); 9115 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) 9116 if (Cand->Viable) 9117 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, 9118 UserDefinedConversion)) 9119 Best = Cand; 9120 9121 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 9122 if (Best == end()) 9123 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 9124 9125 llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands; 9126 9127 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 9128 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 9129 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 9130 if (Cand->Viable && 9131 Cand != Best && 9132 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc, 9133 UserDefinedConversion)) { 9134 if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Best->Function, 9135 Cand->Function)) { 9136 EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function); 9137 continue; 9138 } 9139 9140 Best = end(); 9141 return OR_Ambiguous; 9142 } 9143 } 9144 9145 // Best is the best viable function. 9146 if (Best->Function && 9147 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || 9148 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function))) 9149 return OR_Deleted; 9150 9151 if (!EquivalentCands.empty()) 9152 S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function, 9153 EquivalentCands); 9154 9155 return OR_Success; 9156 } 9157 9158 namespace { 9159 9160 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 9161 oc_function, 9162 oc_method, 9163 oc_constructor, 9164 oc_function_template, 9165 oc_method_template, 9166 oc_constructor_template, 9167 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 9168 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 9169 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 9170 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 9171 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 9172 oc_inherited_constructor, 9173 oc_inherited_constructor_template 9174 }; 9175 9176 static OverloadCandidateKind 9177 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 9178 std::string &Description) { 9179 bool isTemplate = false; 9180 9181 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 9182 isTemplate = true; 9183 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 9184 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 9185 } 9186 9187 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 9188 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) { 9189 if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 9190 return isTemplate ? oc_inherited_constructor_template 9191 : oc_inherited_constructor; 9192 else 9193 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor; 9194 } 9195 9196 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 9197 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 9198 9199 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 9200 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 9201 9202 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 9203 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 9204 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 9205 } 9206 9207 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 9208 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 9209 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 9210 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 9211 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method; 9212 9213 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 9214 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 9215 9216 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 9217 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 9218 9219 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 9220 return oc_method; 9221 } 9222 9223 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function; 9224 } 9225 9226 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) { 9227 // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload 9228 // set. 9229 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)) 9230 S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(), 9231 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor) 9232 << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass(); 9233 } 9234 9235 } // end anonymous namespace 9236 9237 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx, 9238 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 9239 for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) { 9240 bool AlwaysTrue; 9241 if (!EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx)) 9242 return false; 9243 if (!AlwaysTrue) 9244 return false; 9245 } 9246 return true; 9247 } 9248 9249 /// \brief Returns true if we can take the address of the function. 9250 /// 9251 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic 9252 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are 9253 /// we in overload resolution? 9254 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored 9255 /// if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution. 9256 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD, 9257 bool Complain, 9258 bool InOverloadResolution, 9259 SourceLocation Loc) { 9260 if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) { 9261 if (Complain) { 9262 if (InOverloadResolution) 9263 S.Diag(FD->getLocStart(), 9264 diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr); 9265 else 9266 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD; 9267 } 9268 return false; 9269 } 9270 9271 auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 9272 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 9273 }); 9274 if (I == FD->param_end()) 9275 return true; 9276 9277 if (Complain) { 9278 // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing 9279 unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1; 9280 if (InOverloadResolution) 9281 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 9282 diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params) 9283 << ParamNo; 9284 else 9285 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params) 9286 << FD << ParamNo; 9287 } 9288 return false; 9289 } 9290 9291 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S, 9292 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 9293 return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true, 9294 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 9295 /*Loc=*/SourceLocation()); 9296 } 9297 9298 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function, 9299 bool Complain, 9300 SourceLocation Loc) { 9301 return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain, 9302 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 9303 Loc); 9304 } 9305 9306 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 9307 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 9308 QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) { 9309 if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn)) 9310 return; 9311 9312 std::string FnDesc; 9313 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, FnDesc); 9314 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 9315 << (unsigned) K << Fn << FnDesc; 9316 9317 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 9318 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 9319 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found); 9320 } 9321 9322 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 9323 // OverloadedExpr 9324 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType, 9325 bool TakingAddress) { 9326 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 9327 9328 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 9329 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 9330 9331 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 9332 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 9333 I != IEnd; ++I) { 9334 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 9335 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 9336 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType, 9337 TakingAddress); 9338 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 9339 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 9340 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, DestType, TakingAddress); 9341 } 9342 } 9343 } 9344 9345 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 9346 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 9347 /// target types of the conversion. 9348 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 9349 Sema &S, 9350 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 9351 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 9352 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 9353 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 9354 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from 9355 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for 9356 // refactoring here. 9357 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 9358 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 9359 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E; 9360 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9361 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 9362 break; 9363 ++CandsShown; 9364 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second); 9365 } 9366 if (I != E) 9367 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 9368 } 9369 9370 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9371 unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 9372 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 9373 assert(Conv.isBad()); 9374 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 9375 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 9376 9377 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 9378 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 9379 // conversion-slot index. 9380 bool isObjectArgument = false; 9381 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 9382 if (I == 0) 9383 isObjectArgument = true; 9384 else 9385 I--; 9386 } 9387 9388 std::string FnDesc; 9389 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = 9390 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, FnDesc); 9391 9392 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 9393 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 9394 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 9395 9396 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 9397 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 9398 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 9399 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 9400 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 9401 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 9402 9403 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 9404 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9405 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9406 << ToTy << Name << I+1; 9407 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9408 return; 9409 } 9410 9411 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 9412 // to a qualifier mismatch. 9413 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 9414 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 9415 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 9416 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 9417 else { 9418 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 9419 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 9420 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9421 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(); 9422 CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 9423 } 9424 } 9425 9426 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 9427 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 9428 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 9429 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 9430 9431 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 9432 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 9433 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9434 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9435 << FromTy 9436 << FromQs.getAddressSpaceAttributePrintValue() 9437 << ToQs.getAddressSpaceAttributePrintValue() 9438 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 9439 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9440 return; 9441 } 9442 9443 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 9444 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 9445 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9446 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9447 << FromTy 9448 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 9449 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 9450 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9451 return; 9452 } 9453 9454 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 9455 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 9456 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9457 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9458 << FromTy 9459 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 9460 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 9461 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9462 return; 9463 } 9464 9465 if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) { 9466 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned) 9467 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9468 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9469 << FromTy << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I+1; 9470 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9471 return; 9472 } 9473 9474 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 9475 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 9476 9477 if (isObjectArgument) { 9478 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 9479 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9480 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9481 << FromTy << (CVR - 1); 9482 } else { 9483 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 9484 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9485 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9486 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1; 9487 } 9488 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9489 return; 9490 } 9491 9492 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 9493 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 9494 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 9495 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 9496 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9497 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9498 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 9499 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9500 return; 9501 } 9502 9503 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 9504 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 9505 // the failure. 9506 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 9507 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 9508 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 9509 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 9510 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 9511 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 9512 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9513 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9514 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1 9515 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind); 9516 9517 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9518 return; 9519 } 9520 9521 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 9522 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 9523 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9524 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9525 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 9526 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 9527 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 9528 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 9529 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 9530 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 9531 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 9532 } 9533 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 9534 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 9535 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 9536 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 9537 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 9538 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 9539 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 9540 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 9541 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 9542 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 9543 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 9544 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 9545 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 9546 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 9547 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) { 9548 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 9549 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() && 9550 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() == 9551 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) { 9552 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue) 9553 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9554 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9555 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1; 9556 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9557 return; 9558 } 9559 } 9560 9561 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 9562 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 9563 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 9564 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9565 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9566 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) 9567 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1; 9568 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9569 return; 9570 } 9571 9572 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 9573 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 9574 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 9575 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 9576 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 9577 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 9578 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9579 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9580 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1; 9581 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9582 return; 9583 } 9584 } 9585 9586 if (TakingCandidateAddress && 9587 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function)) 9588 return; 9589 9590 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 9591 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 9592 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc 9593 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9594 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1 9595 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind); 9596 9597 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 9598 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 9599 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 9600 FDiag << *HI; 9601 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 9602 9603 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9604 } 9605 9606 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload 9607 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch() 9608 /// over a candidate in any candidate set. 9609 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9610 unsigned NumArgs) { 9611 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 9612 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 9613 9614 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 9615 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the 9616 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 9617 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 9618 // Just don't report anything. 9619 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 9620 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 9621 return true; 9622 9623 if (NumArgs < MinParams) { 9624 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 9625 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 9626 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 9627 } else { 9628 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 9629 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 9630 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 9631 } 9632 9633 return false; 9634 } 9635 9636 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set. 9637 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D, 9638 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 9639 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 9640 "The templated declaration should at least be a function" 9641 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many" 9642 " or too few arguments"); 9643 9644 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 9645 9646 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 9647 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9648 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 9649 9650 // at least / at most / exactly 9651 unsigned mode, modeCount; 9652 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 9653 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() || 9654 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 9655 mode = 0; // "at least" 9656 else 9657 mode = 2; // "exactly" 9658 modeCount = MinParams; 9659 } else { 9660 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams()) 9661 mode = 1; // "at most" 9662 else 9663 mode = 2; // "exactly" 9664 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams(); 9665 } 9666 9667 std::string Description; 9668 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = 9669 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, Description); 9670 9671 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 9672 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 9673 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr) 9674 << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 9675 else 9676 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 9677 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr) 9678 << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 9679 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9680 } 9681 9682 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate. 9683 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9684 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 9685 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs)) 9686 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs); 9687 } 9688 9689 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) { 9690 if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate()) 9691 return TD; 9692 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration" 9693 " for bad deduction diagnosis"); 9694 } 9695 9696 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 9697 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated, 9698 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure, 9699 unsigned NumArgs, 9700 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 9701 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 9702 NamedDecl *ParamD; 9703 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 9704 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 9705 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 9706 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) { 9707 case Sema::TDK_Success: 9708 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 9709 9710 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 9711 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 9712 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9713 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 9714 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 9715 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9716 return; 9717 } 9718 9719 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 9720 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 9721 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 9722 9723 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 9724 9725 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 9726 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 9727 QualifierCollector Qs; 9728 Qs.strip(Param); 9729 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 9730 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 9731 9732 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 9733 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 9734 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 9735 // done on dependent types). 9736 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 9737 9738 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 9739 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 9740 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9741 return; 9742 } 9743 9744 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 9745 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 9746 int which = 0; 9747 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9748 which = 0; 9749 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) { 9750 // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two 9751 // different types for a non-type template parameter. 9752 // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this. 9753 QualType T1 = 9754 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 9755 QualType T2 = 9756 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 9757 if (!S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) { 9758 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9759 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types) 9760 << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1 9761 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2; 9762 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9763 return; 9764 } 9765 9766 which = 1; 9767 } else { 9768 which = 2; 9769 } 9770 9771 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9772 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 9773 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 9774 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 9775 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9776 return; 9777 } 9778 9779 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 9780 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 9781 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 9782 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9783 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 9784 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 9785 else { 9786 int index = 0; 9787 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9788 index = TTP->getIndex(); 9789 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 9790 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9791 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 9792 else 9793 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 9794 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9795 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 9796 << (index + 1); 9797 } 9798 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9799 return; 9800 9801 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 9802 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 9803 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs); 9804 return; 9805 9806 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 9807 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9808 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 9809 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9810 return; 9811 9812 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 9813 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 9814 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 9815 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 9816 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 9817 TemplateArgString = " "; 9818 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 9819 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 9820 } 9821 9822 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 9823 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 9824 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 9825 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 9826 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 9827 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 9828 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 9829 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 9830 return; 9831 } 9832 9833 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 9834 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 9835 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 9836 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 9837 SourceRange R; 9838 if (PDiag) { 9839 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 9840 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 9841 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 9842 } 9843 9844 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9845 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 9846 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 9847 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9848 return; 9849 } 9850 9851 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 9852 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 9853 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 9854 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 9855 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 9856 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 9857 TemplateArgString = " "; 9858 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 9859 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 9860 } 9861 9862 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch) 9863 << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1) 9864 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() 9865 << TemplateArgString 9866 << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested); 9867 break; 9868 } 9869 9870 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 9871 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match. 9872 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 9873 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 9874 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template && 9875 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) { 9876 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate(); 9877 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate(); 9878 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template && 9879 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) { 9880 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() == 9881 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) { 9882 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named 9883 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since: 9884 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer. 9885 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better 9886 // name for types, not decls. 9887 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer. 9888 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9889 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified) 9890 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 9891 return; 9892 } 9893 } 9894 } 9895 9896 if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) && 9897 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))) 9898 return; 9899 9900 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda 9901 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative 9902 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to 9903 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters. 9904 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9905 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch) 9906 << FirstTA << SecondTA; 9907 return; 9908 } 9909 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 9910 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 9911 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 9912 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 9913 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9914 return; 9915 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 9916 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9917 diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch); 9918 return; 9919 } 9920 } 9921 9922 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls. 9923 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9924 unsigned NumArgs, 9925 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 9926 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result; 9927 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) { 9928 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs)) 9929 return; 9930 } 9931 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern 9932 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress); 9933 } 9934 9935 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 9936 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9937 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9938 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 9939 9940 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 9941 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 9942 9943 std::string FnDesc; 9944 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = 9945 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee, FnDesc); 9946 9947 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 9948 << (unsigned)FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 9949 9950 // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the 9951 // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case. 9952 CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee); 9953 if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) { 9954 CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent(); 9955 Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM; 9956 9957 switch (FnKind) { 9958 default: 9959 return; 9960 case oc_implicit_default_constructor: 9961 CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 9962 break; 9963 case oc_implicit_copy_constructor: 9964 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 9965 break; 9966 case oc_implicit_move_constructor: 9967 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 9968 break; 9969 case oc_implicit_copy_assignment: 9970 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 9971 break; 9972 case oc_implicit_move_assignment: 9973 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 9974 break; 9975 }; 9976 9977 bool ConstRHS = false; 9978 if (Meth->getNumParams()) { 9979 if (const ReferenceType *RT = 9980 Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 9981 ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified(); 9982 } 9983 } 9984 9985 S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth, 9986 /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS, 9987 /* Diagnose */ true); 9988 } 9989 } 9990 9991 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9992 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 9993 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data); 9994 9995 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 9996 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 9997 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 9998 } 9999 10000 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10001 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10002 10003 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 10004 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension); 10005 } 10006 10007 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 10008 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 10009 /// 10010 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 10011 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 10012 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 10013 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 10014 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 10015 /// overload. 10016 /// 10017 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 10018 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 10019 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 10020 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10021 unsigned NumArgs, 10022 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10023 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10024 10025 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 10026 if (Cand->Viable) { 10027 if (Fn->isDeleted() || S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn)) { 10028 std::string FnDesc; 10029 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = 10030 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, FnDesc); 10031 10032 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 10033 << FnKind << FnDesc 10034 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 10035 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10036 return; 10037 } 10038 10039 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 10040 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn); 10041 return; 10042 } 10043 10044 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 10045 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 10046 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 10047 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 10048 10049 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 10050 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs, 10051 TakingCandidateAddress); 10052 10053 case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: { 10054 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor) 10055 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0); 10056 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10057 return; 10058 } 10059 10060 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 10061 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 10062 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 10063 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn); 10064 10065 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 10066 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 10067 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I) 10068 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 10069 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress); 10070 10071 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 10072 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 10073 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 10074 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn); 10075 } 10076 10077 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 10078 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 10079 10080 case ovl_fail_enable_if: 10081 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand); 10082 10083 case ovl_fail_ext_disabled: 10084 return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand); 10085 10086 case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice: 10087 // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here. 10088 if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor()) 10089 return; 10090 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 10091 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice) 10092 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0) 10093 << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType(); 10094 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10095 return; 10096 10097 case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: { 10098 bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function); 10099 (void)Available; 10100 assert(!Available); 10101 break; 10102 } 10103 } 10104 } 10105 10106 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10107 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 10108 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 10109 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 10110 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 10111 bool isLValueReference = false; 10112 bool isRValueReference = false; 10113 bool isPointer = false; 10114 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 10115 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 10116 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 10117 isLValueReference = true; 10118 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 10119 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 10120 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 10121 isRValueReference = true; 10122 } 10123 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10124 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 10125 isPointer = true; 10126 } 10127 // Desugar down to a function type. 10128 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 10129 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 10130 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 10131 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 10132 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 10133 10134 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 10135 << FnType; 10136 } 10137 10138 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc, 10139 SourceLocation OpLoc, 10140 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10141 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 10142 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 10143 TypeStr += Opc; 10144 TypeStr += "("; 10145 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 10146 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) { 10147 TypeStr += ")"; 10148 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr; 10149 } else { 10150 TypeStr += ", "; 10151 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 10152 TypeStr += ")"; 10153 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr; 10154 } 10155 } 10156 10157 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10158 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10159 for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) { 10160 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 10161 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 10162 10163 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 10164 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 10165 } 10166 } 10167 10168 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10169 if (Cand->Function) 10170 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 10171 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 10172 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 10173 return SourceLocation(); 10174 } 10175 10176 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 10177 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 10178 case Sema::TDK_Success: 10179 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 10180 llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction"); 10181 10182 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 10183 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 10184 return 1; 10185 10186 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 10187 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 10188 return 2; 10189 10190 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 10191 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 10192 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 10193 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 10194 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 10195 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 10196 return 3; 10197 10198 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 10199 return 4; 10200 10201 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 10202 return 5; 10203 10204 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 10205 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 10206 return 6; 10207 } 10208 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 10209 } 10210 10211 namespace { 10212 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 10213 Sema &S; 10214 SourceLocation Loc; 10215 size_t NumArgs; 10216 10217 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t nArgs) 10218 : S(S), NumArgs(nArgs) {} 10219 10220 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 10221 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 10222 // Fast-path this check. 10223 if (L == R) return false; 10224 10225 // Order first by viability. 10226 if (L->Viable) { 10227 if (!R->Viable) return true; 10228 10229 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 10230 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 10231 // that could exploit it. 10232 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true; 10233 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false; 10234 } else if (R->Viable) 10235 return false; 10236 10237 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 10238 10239 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 10240 if (!L->Viable) { 10241 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 10242 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 10243 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 10244 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 10245 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 10246 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 10247 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 10248 if (LDist == RDist) { 10249 if (L->FailureKind == R->FailureKind) 10250 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates. 10251 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate; 10252 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were 10253 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters 10254 // than there were arguments given. 10255 return L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 10256 } 10257 return LDist < RDist; 10258 } 10259 return false; 10260 } 10261 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 10262 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 10263 return true; 10264 10265 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 10266 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 10267 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 10268 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 10269 return true; 10270 10271 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 10272 // comes first. 10273 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 10274 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 10275 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 10276 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 10277 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 10278 return numLFixes < numRFixes; 10279 } 10280 10281 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 10282 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 10283 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size()); 10284 10285 int leftBetter = 0; 10286 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 10287 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) { 10288 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 10289 L->Conversions[I], 10290 R->Conversions[I])) { 10291 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 10292 leftBetter++; 10293 break; 10294 10295 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 10296 leftBetter--; 10297 break; 10298 10299 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 10300 break; 10301 } 10302 } 10303 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 10304 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 10305 10306 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 10307 return false; 10308 10309 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 10310 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 10311 return true; 10312 10313 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 10314 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 10315 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 10316 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 10317 return false; 10318 10319 // TODO: others? 10320 } 10321 10322 // Sort everything else by location. 10323 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 10324 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 10325 10326 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 10327 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 10328 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 10329 10330 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 10331 } 10332 }; 10333 } 10334 10335 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 10336 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if 10337 /// possible. 10338 static void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10339 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 10340 assert(!Cand->Viable); 10341 10342 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 10343 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return; 10344 10345 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 10346 bool Unfixable = false; 10347 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 10348 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 10349 10350 // Attempt to fix the bad conversion. 10351 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size(); 10352 for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/; 10353 ++ConvIdx) { 10354 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 10355 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 10356 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 10357 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 10358 break; 10359 } 10360 } 10361 10362 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 10363 // operation somehow. 10364 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 10365 10366 unsigned ConvIdx = 0; 10367 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes; 10368 10369 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 10370 QualType ConvType 10371 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 10372 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 10373 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 10374 ParamTypes = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 10375 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding argument. 10376 ConvIdx = 1; 10377 } else if (Cand->Function) { 10378 ParamTypes = 10379 Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 10380 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 10381 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function)) { 10382 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding argument. 10383 ConvIdx = 1; 10384 } 10385 } else { 10386 // Builtin operator. 10387 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 10388 ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes; 10389 } 10390 10391 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 10392 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) { 10393 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 10394 // We've already checked this conversion. 10395 } else if (ArgIdx < ParamTypes.size()) { 10396 if (ParamTypes[ArgIdx]->isDependentType()) 10397 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion( 10398 Args[ArgIdx]->getType()); 10399 else { 10400 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = 10401 TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ArgIdx], 10402 SuppressUserConversions, 10403 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 10404 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 10405 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 10406 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 10407 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 10408 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 10409 } 10410 } else 10411 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 10412 } 10413 } 10414 10415 /// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints 10416 /// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate 10417 /// set. 10418 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates( 10419 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 10420 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10421 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 10422 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 10423 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 10424 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 10425 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 10426 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 10427 if (!Filter(*Cand)) 10428 continue; 10429 if (Cand->Viable) 10430 Cands.push_back(Cand); 10431 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) { 10432 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args); 10433 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate) 10434 Cands.push_back(Cand); 10435 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 10436 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 10437 } 10438 } 10439 10440 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 10441 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size())); 10442 10443 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 10444 10445 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E; 10446 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 10447 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10448 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10449 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 10450 10451 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 10452 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 10453 // candidate list. 10454 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) { 10455 break; 10456 } 10457 ++CandsShown; 10458 10459 if (Cand->Function) 10460 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(), 10461 /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false); 10462 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 10463 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 10464 else { 10465 assert(Cand->Viable && 10466 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 10467 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 10468 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 10469 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 10470 // 10471 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 10472 // different ambiguities, though. 10473 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 10474 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 10475 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 10476 } 10477 10478 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 10479 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 10480 } 10481 } 10482 10483 if (I != E) 10484 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10485 } 10486 10487 static SourceLocation 10488 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) { 10489 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation() 10490 : SourceLocation(); 10491 } 10492 10493 namespace { 10494 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay { 10495 Sema &S; 10496 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 10497 10498 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L, 10499 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) { 10500 // Fast-path this check. 10501 if (L == R) 10502 return false; 10503 10504 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches... 10505 10506 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures. 10507 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 10508 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) < 10509 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 10510 10511 // Sort everything else by location. 10512 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 10513 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 10514 10515 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 10516 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) 10517 return false; 10518 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) 10519 return true; 10520 10521 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 10522 } 10523 }; 10524 } 10525 10526 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure. 10527 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad 10528 /// deductions. 10529 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S, 10530 bool ForTakingAddress) { 10531 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern 10532 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress); 10533 } 10534 10535 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 10536 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 10537 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 10538 } 10539 } 10540 10541 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() { 10542 destroyCandidates(); 10543 Candidates.clear(); 10544 } 10545 10546 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints 10547 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form 10548 /// the candidate set. 10549 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with 10550 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false. 10551 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 10552 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match). 10553 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers 10554 // and sort those. 10555 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands; 10556 Cands.reserve(size()); 10557 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 10558 if (Cand->Specialization) 10559 Cands.push_back(Cand); 10560 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not, 10561 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate. 10562 } 10563 10564 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 10565 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 10566 10567 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads() 10568 // for generalization purposes (?). 10569 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 10570 10571 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E; 10572 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10573 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10574 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I; 10575 10576 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam 10577 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 10578 // candidate list. 10579 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 10580 break; 10581 ++CandsShown; 10582 10583 assert(Cand->Specialization && 10584 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 10585 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress); 10586 } 10587 10588 if (I != E) 10589 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10590 } 10591 10592 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 10593 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 10594 // R (A) --> R(A) 10595 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 10596 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 10597 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 10598 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 10599 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 10600 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 10601 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 10602 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 10603 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 10604 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 10605 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 10606 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 10607 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 10608 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 10609 Ret = 10610 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 10611 return Ret; 10612 } 10613 10614 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc, 10615 bool Complain = true) { 10616 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 10617 S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain)) 10618 return true; 10619 10620 auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10621 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1z && 10622 isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) && 10623 !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT)) 10624 return true; 10625 10626 return false; 10627 } 10628 10629 namespace { 10630 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 10631 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 10632 class AddressOfFunctionResolver { 10633 Sema& S; 10634 Expr* SourceExpr; 10635 const QualType& TargetType; 10636 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 10637 10638 bool Complain; 10639 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 10640 ASTContext& Context; 10641 10642 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 10643 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 10644 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 10645 bool HasComplained; 10646 10647 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 10648 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 10649 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 10650 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 10651 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates; 10652 10653 public: 10654 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr, 10655 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain) 10656 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 10657 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 10658 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 10659 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 10660 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 10661 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false), 10662 HasComplained(false), 10663 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 10664 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression), 10665 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) { 10666 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 10667 10668 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 10669 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr)) 10670 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() && 10671 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME)) 10672 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true; 10673 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 10674 DeclAccessPair dap; 10675 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 10676 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) { 10677 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) 10678 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 10679 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found 10680 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the 10681 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 10682 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 10683 10684 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 10685 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 10686 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 10687 return; 10688 } 10689 10690 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn)); 10691 } 10692 return; 10693 } 10694 10695 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 10696 OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 10697 10698 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 10699 // C++ [over.over]p4: 10700 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 10701 if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) { 10702 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 10703 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 10704 else 10705 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 10706 } 10707 } 10708 10709 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1) 10710 EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches(); 10711 } 10712 10713 bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; } 10714 10715 private: 10716 bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10717 QualType Discard; 10718 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) || 10719 S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard); 10720 } 10721 10722 /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the 10723 /// desired type than B. 10724 bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) { 10725 // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it 10726 // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to 10727 // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match. 10728 return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) && 10729 (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) || 10730 compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better); 10731 } 10732 10733 /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate, 10734 /// false otherwise. 10735 bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() { 10736 // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best", 10737 // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best. 10738 auto Best = Matches.begin(); 10739 for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I) 10740 if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second)) 10741 Best = I; 10742 10743 const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second; 10744 auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn]( 10745 const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) { 10746 return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second); 10747 }; 10748 10749 // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best 10750 // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error 10751 if (!std::all_of(Matches.begin(), Matches.end(), IsBestOrInferiorToBest)) 10752 return false; 10753 Matches[0] = *Best; 10754 Matches.resize(1); 10755 return true; 10756 } 10757 10758 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 10759 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 10760 } 10761 10762 // [ToType] [Return] 10763 10764 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 10765 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 10766 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 10767 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 10768 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 10769 } 10770 10771 // return true if any matching specializations were found 10772 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 10773 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 10774 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 10775 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 10776 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 10777 // static when converting to member pointer. 10778 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10779 return false; 10780 } 10781 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10782 return false; 10783 10784 // C++ [over.over]p2: 10785 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 10786 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 10787 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 10788 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 10789 // overloaded functions considered. 10790 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 10791 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 10792 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 10793 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 10794 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 10795 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 10796 Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 10797 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 10798 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 10799 .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 10800 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 10801 return false; 10802 } 10803 10804 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or 10805 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS. 10806 // This function template specicalization works. 10807 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType( 10808 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()), 10809 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType))); 10810 10811 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization)) 10812 return false; 10813 10814 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 10815 return true; 10816 } 10817 10818 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 10819 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 10820 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 10821 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 10822 // when converting to member pointer. 10823 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10824 return false; 10825 } 10826 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10827 return false; 10828 10829 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 10830 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 10831 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 10832 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl)) 10833 return false; 10834 10835 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction 10836 // now. 10837 if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), 10838 Complain)) { 10839 HasComplained |= Complain; 10840 return false; 10841 } 10842 10843 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl)) 10844 return false; 10845 10846 // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical. 10847 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 10848 candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) { 10849 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair( 10850 CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 10851 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 10852 return true; 10853 } 10854 } 10855 10856 return false; 10857 } 10858 10859 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 10860 bool Ret = false; 10861 10862 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 10863 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 10864 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 10865 return false; 10866 10867 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10868 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10869 I != E; ++I) { 10870 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 10871 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 10872 10873 // C++ [over.over]p3: 10874 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 10875 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 10876 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 10877 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 10878 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 10879 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 10880 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 10881 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 10882 Ret = true; 10883 } 10884 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 10885 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 10886 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 10887 Ret = true; 10888 } 10889 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 10890 return Ret; 10891 } 10892 10893 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 10894 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 10895 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 10896 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 10897 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 10898 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 10899 10900 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 10901 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 10902 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 10903 // best function template (if it exists). 10904 10905 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 10906 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 10907 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 10908 10909 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose 10910 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0. 10911 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized( 10912 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates, 10913 SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(), 10914 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 10915 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 10916 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 10917 << (unsigned)oc_function_template, 10918 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 10919 10920 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 10921 // Make it the first and only element 10922 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 10923 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 10924 Matches.resize(1); 10925 } else 10926 HasComplained |= Complain; 10927 } 10928 10929 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 10930 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 10931 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 10932 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 10933 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr) 10934 ++I; 10935 else { 10936 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 10937 Matches.resize(N); 10938 } 10939 } 10940 } 10941 10942 void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() { 10943 S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches); 10944 } 10945 10946 public: 10947 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 10948 assert(Matches.empty()); 10949 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 10950 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 10951 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 10952 if (FailedCandidates.empty()) 10953 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 10954 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 10955 else { 10956 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose 10957 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates 10958 // normally. 10959 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10960 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10961 I != IEnd; ++I) 10962 if (FunctionDecl *Fun = 10963 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 10964 if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun)) 10965 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, TargetFunctionType, 10966 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 10967 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart()); 10968 } 10969 } 10970 10971 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 10972 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 10973 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 10974 } 10975 10976 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 10977 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 10978 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 10979 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 10980 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 10981 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 10982 } 10983 10984 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 10985 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 10986 } 10987 10988 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 10989 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), 10990 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 10991 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 10992 } 10993 10994 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 10995 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 10996 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 10997 } 10998 10999 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 11000 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 11001 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 11002 << OvlExpr->getName() 11003 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11004 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 11005 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 11006 } 11007 11008 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 11009 11010 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 11011 11012 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 11013 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 11014 return Matches[0].second; 11015 } 11016 11017 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 11018 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 11019 return &Matches[0].first; 11020 } 11021 }; 11022 } 11023 11024 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 11025 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 11026 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 11027 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 11028 /// 11029 /// @code 11030 /// int f(double); 11031 /// int f(int); 11032 /// 11033 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 11034 /// @endcode 11035 /// 11036 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 11037 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 11038 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 11039 FunctionDecl * 11040 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 11041 QualType TargetType, 11042 bool Complain, 11043 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 11044 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 11045 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 11046 11047 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 11048 Complain); 11049 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 11050 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr; 11051 bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained(); 11052 if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) { 11053 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 11054 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 11055 else 11056 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 11057 } 11058 else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain) 11059 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 11060 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 11061 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 11062 assert(Fn); 11063 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 11064 ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT); 11065 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 11066 if (Complain) { 11067 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer()) 11068 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(); 11069 else 11070 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 11071 } 11072 } 11073 11074 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 11075 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 11076 return Fn; 11077 } 11078 11079 /// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 11080 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken. 11081 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null. 11082 /// 11083 /// This routine can only realistically succeed if all but one candidates in the 11084 /// overload set for SrcExpr cannot have their addresses taken. 11085 FunctionDecl * 11086 Sema::resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, 11087 DeclAccessPair &Pair) { 11088 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E); 11089 OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression; 11090 FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr; 11091 DeclAccessPair DAP; 11092 // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for 11093 // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks 11094 // enable_if/pass_object_size/... 11095 for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 11096 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl()); 11097 if (!FD) 11098 return nullptr; 11099 11100 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 11101 continue; 11102 11103 // We have more than one result; quit. 11104 if (Result) 11105 return nullptr; 11106 DAP = I.getPair(); 11107 Result = FD; 11108 } 11109 11110 if (Result) 11111 Pair = DAP; 11112 return Result; 11113 } 11114 11115 /// \brief Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded 11116 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate. This 11117 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if 11118 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay. 11119 /// 11120 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate fails. 11121 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true. 11122 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate( 11123 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) { 11124 Expr *E = SrcExpr.get(); 11125 assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload"); 11126 11127 DeclAccessPair DAP; 11128 FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(E, DAP); 11129 if (!Found) 11130 return false; 11131 11132 // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and 11133 // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check 11134 // for both. 11135 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc()); 11136 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP); 11137 Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found); 11138 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType()) 11139 SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false); 11140 else 11141 SrcExpr = Fixed; 11142 return true; 11143 } 11144 11145 /// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 11146 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 11147 /// 11148 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 11149 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 11150 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 11151 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 11152 /// 11153 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is 11154 /// returned. 11155 FunctionDecl * 11156 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 11157 bool Complain, 11158 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 11159 // C++ [over.over]p1: 11160 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 11161 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 11162 // C++ [over.over]p1: 11163 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 11164 // operator. 11165 11166 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 11167 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 11168 return nullptr; 11169 11170 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 11171 ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 11172 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc()); 11173 11174 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 11175 // whose type matches exactly. 11176 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr; 11177 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 11178 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 11179 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 11180 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 11181 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 11182 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 11183 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 11184 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 11185 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 11186 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 11187 11188 // C++ [over.over]p2: 11189 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 11190 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 11191 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 11192 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 11193 // overloaded functions considered. 11194 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 11195 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 11196 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 11197 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 11198 Specialization, Info, 11199 /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 11200 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 11201 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info? 11202 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 11203 .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 11204 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 11205 continue; 11206 } 11207 11208 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 11209 11210 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 11211 if (Matched) { 11212 if (Complain) { 11213 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 11214 << ovl->getName(); 11215 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 11216 } 11217 return nullptr; 11218 } 11219 11220 Matched = Specialization; 11221 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 11222 } 11223 11224 if (Matched && 11225 completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain)) 11226 return nullptr; 11227 11228 return Matched; 11229 } 11230 11231 11232 11233 11234 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 11235 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 11236 // 11237 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 11238 // 11239 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 11240 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 11241 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 11242 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11243 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 11244 bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining, 11245 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 11246 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 11247 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 11248 11249 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 11250 11251 DeclAccessPair found; 11252 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 11253 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11254 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 11255 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) { 11256 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 11257 return true; 11258 } 11259 11260 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 11261 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 11262 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 11263 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 11264 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 11265 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 11266 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 11267 if (!complain) return false; 11268 11269 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 11270 diag::err_bound_member_function) 11271 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 11272 11273 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 11274 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 11275 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 11276 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 11277 // the static candidates were rejected. 11278 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 11279 return true; 11280 } 11281 11282 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'. 11283 SingleFunctionExpression = 11284 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn); 11285 11286 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 11287 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 11288 SingleFunctionExpression = 11289 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get()); 11290 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 11291 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 11292 return true; 11293 } 11294 } 11295 } 11296 11297 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 11298 if (complain) { 11299 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 11300 << ovl.Expression->getName() 11301 << DestTypeForComplaining 11302 << OpRangeForComplaining 11303 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 11304 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 11305 11306 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 11307 return true; 11308 } 11309 11310 return false; 11311 } 11312 11313 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 11314 return true; 11315 } 11316 11317 /// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set. 11318 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 11319 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 11320 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 11321 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11322 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 11323 bool PartialOverloading, 11324 bool KnownValid) { 11325 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 11326 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 11327 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 11328 11329 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 11330 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 11331 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 11332 return; 11333 } 11334 // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates. 11335 if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>())) 11336 return; 11337 11338 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 11339 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false, 11340 PartialOverloading); 11341 return; 11342 } 11343 11344 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 11345 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 11346 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 11347 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 11348 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false, 11349 PartialOverloading); 11350 return; 11351 } 11352 11353 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 11354 } 11355 11356 /// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 11357 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 11358 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11359 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11360 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 11361 bool PartialOverloading) { 11362 11363 #ifndef NDEBUG 11364 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 11365 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 11366 // 11367 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 11368 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 11369 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 11370 // 11371 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 11372 // 11373 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 11374 // using-declaration, or 11375 // 11376 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 11377 // template 11378 // 11379 // then Y is empty. 11380 11381 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 11382 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 11383 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 11384 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 11385 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 11386 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 11387 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 11388 } 11389 } 11390 #endif 11391 11392 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 11393 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 11394 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 11395 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11396 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 11397 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 11398 } 11399 11400 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 11401 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 11402 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 11403 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 11404 /*KnownValid*/ true); 11405 11406 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 11407 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(), 11408 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 11409 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 11410 } 11411 11412 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into 11413 /// a different namespace. 11414 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) { 11415 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) { 11416 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New: 11417 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete: 11418 return false; 11419 11420 default: 11421 return true; 11422 } 11423 } 11424 11425 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 11426 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 11427 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 11428 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 11429 /// 11430 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 11431 static bool 11432 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, 11433 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 11434 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK, 11435 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 11436 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11437 bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) { 11438 if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty()) 11439 return false; 11440 11441 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 11442 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 11443 continue; 11444 11445 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 11446 11447 if (!R.empty()) { 11448 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 11449 11450 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 11451 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better 11452 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup. 11453 R.clear(); 11454 if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) 11455 *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true; 11456 return false; 11457 } 11458 11459 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK); 11460 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 11461 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(), 11462 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 11463 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 11464 11465 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11466 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) { 11467 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions 11468 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway. 11469 R.clear(); 11470 return false; 11471 } 11472 11473 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 11474 // declaring the function there instead. 11475 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 11476 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 11477 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args, 11478 AssociatedNamespaces, 11479 AssociatedClasses); 11480 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 11481 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) { 11482 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace(); 11483 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 11484 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 11485 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 11486 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 11487 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it)) 11488 continue; 11489 11490 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a 11491 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx. 11492 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it); 11493 if (NS && 11494 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos) 11495 continue; 11496 11497 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 11498 } 11499 } 11500 11501 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 11502 << R.getLookupName(); 11503 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 11504 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 11505 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 11506 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 11507 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 11508 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 11509 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 11510 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 11511 } else { 11512 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 11513 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 11514 // a localized representation of a list of items. 11515 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 11516 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 11517 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 11518 } 11519 11520 // Try to recover by calling this function. 11521 return true; 11522 } 11523 11524 R.clear(); 11525 } 11526 11527 return false; 11528 } 11529 11530 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 11531 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 11532 /// was defined. 11533 /// 11534 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 11535 static bool 11536 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 11537 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11538 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 11539 DeclarationName OpName = 11540 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 11541 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 11542 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 11543 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 11544 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args); 11545 } 11546 11547 namespace { 11548 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII { 11549 Sema &SemaRef; 11550 public: 11551 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) { 11552 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false); 11553 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true; 11554 } 11555 11556 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() { 11557 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false; 11558 } 11559 }; 11560 11561 } 11562 11563 static std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> 11564 MakeValidator(Sema &SemaRef, MemberExpr *ME, size_t NumArgs, 11565 bool HasTemplateArgs, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 11566 if (!AllowTypoCorrection) 11567 return llvm::make_unique<NoTypoCorrectionCCC>(); 11568 return llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallFilterCCC>(SemaRef, NumArgs, 11569 HasTemplateArgs, ME); 11570 } 11571 11572 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 11573 /// 11574 /// Returns true if new candidates were found. 11575 static ExprResult 11576 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 11577 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11578 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 11579 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11580 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 11581 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 11582 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call. 11583 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like 11584 // 11585 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {} 11586 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {} 11587 // 11588 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr) 11589 return ExprError(); 11590 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef); 11591 11592 CXXScopeSpec SS; 11593 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 11594 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 11595 11596 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 11597 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 11598 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11599 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 11600 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 11601 } 11602 11603 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 11604 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 11605 bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup; 11606 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, 11607 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal, 11608 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 11609 &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) && 11610 (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup || SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup( 11611 S, SS, R, 11612 MakeValidator(SemaRef, dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn), Args.size(), 11613 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, AllowTypoCorrection), 11614 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args))) 11615 return ExprError(); 11616 11617 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 11618 11619 // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out. 11620 if (R.isAmbiguous()) { 11621 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 11622 return ExprError(); 11623 } 11624 11625 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 11626 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 11627 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 11628 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 11629 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, 11630 ExplicitTemplateArgs, S); 11631 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 11632 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 11633 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 11634 else 11635 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 11636 11637 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 11638 return ExprError(); 11639 11640 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 11641 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never 11642 // end up here. 11643 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc, 11644 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), 11645 RParenLoc); 11646 } 11647 11648 /// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from 11649 /// the given function. 11650 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set. 11651 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 11652 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11653 MultiExprArg Args, 11654 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 11655 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 11656 ExprResult *Result) { 11657 #ifndef NDEBUG 11658 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 11659 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 11660 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 11661 11662 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 11663 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 11664 FunctionDecl *F; 11665 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 11666 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 11667 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 11668 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 11669 11670 // We don't perform ADL in C. 11671 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 11672 } 11673 #endif 11674 11675 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 11676 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) { 11677 *Result = ExprError(); 11678 return true; 11679 } 11680 11681 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 11682 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 11683 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet); 11684 11685 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 11686 CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() && 11687 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 11688 11689 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11690 if (CandidateSet->empty() || 11691 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best) == 11692 OR_No_Viable_Function) { 11693 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then 11694 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup 11695 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base 11696 // classes. 11697 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr( 11698 Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 11699 CE->setTypeDependent(true); 11700 CE->setValueDependent(true); 11701 CE->setInstantiationDependent(true); 11702 *Result = CE; 11703 return true; 11704 } 11705 } 11706 11707 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 11708 return false; 11709 11710 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 11711 return false; 11712 } 11713 11714 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns 11715 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits 11716 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError() 11717 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 11718 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11719 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 11720 MultiExprArg Args, 11721 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 11722 Expr *ExecConfig, 11723 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 11724 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best, 11725 OverloadingResult OverloadResult, 11726 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 11727 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 11728 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 11729 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true, 11730 AllowTypoCorrection); 11731 11732 switch (OverloadResult) { 11733 case OR_Success: { 11734 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 11735 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl); 11736 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc())) 11737 return ExprError(); 11738 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 11739 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 11740 ExecConfig); 11741 } 11742 11743 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 11744 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 11745 // have meant to call. 11746 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 11747 Args, RParenLoc, 11748 /*EmptyLookup=*/false, 11749 AllowTypoCorrection); 11750 if (!Recovery.isInvalid()) 11751 return Recovery; 11752 11753 // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we 11754 // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to 11755 // emit better ones. 11756 for (const Expr *Arg : Args) { 11757 if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType()) 11758 continue; 11759 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) { 11760 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 11761 if (FD && 11762 !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 11763 Arg->getExprLoc())) 11764 return ExprError(); 11765 } 11766 } 11767 11768 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 11769 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 11770 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11771 break; 11772 } 11773 11774 case OR_Ambiguous: 11775 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 11776 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 11777 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 11778 break; 11779 11780 case OR_Deleted: { 11781 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 11782 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted() 11783 << ULE->getName() 11784 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function) 11785 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 11786 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11787 11788 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep 11789 // the call in the AST. 11790 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 11791 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 11792 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 11793 ExecConfig); 11794 } 11795 } 11796 11797 // Overload resolution failed. 11798 return ExprError(); 11799 } 11800 11801 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S, 11802 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) { 11803 for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) { 11804 if (I->Viable && 11805 !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) { 11806 I->Viable = false; 11807 I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available; 11808 } 11809 } 11810 } 11811 11812 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn 11813 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 11814 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 11815 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 11816 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution. 11817 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError. 11818 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 11819 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11820 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 11821 MultiExprArg Args, 11822 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 11823 Expr *ExecConfig, 11824 bool AllowTypoCorrection, 11825 bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) { 11826 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(), 11827 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 11828 ExprResult result; 11829 11830 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet, 11831 &result)) 11832 return result; 11833 11834 // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that 11835 // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable. 11836 if (CalleesAddressIsTaken) 11837 markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet); 11838 11839 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11840 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 11841 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best); 11842 11843 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 11844 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, 11845 &Best, OverloadResult, 11846 AllowTypoCorrection); 11847 } 11848 11849 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 11850 return Functions.size() > 1 || 11851 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin())); 11852 } 11853 11854 /// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 11855 /// operator. 11856 /// 11857 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 11858 /// 11859 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 11860 /// 11861 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 11862 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 11863 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 11864 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 11865 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 11866 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 11867 /// 11868 /// \param Input The input argument. 11869 ExprResult 11870 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 11871 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 11872 Expr *Input) { 11873 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 11874 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 11875 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 11876 // TODO: provide better source location info. 11877 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 11878 11879 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 11880 return ExprError(); 11881 11882 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr }; 11883 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 11884 11885 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 11886 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 11887 // post-decrement. 11888 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 11889 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 11890 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 11891 SourceLocation()); 11892 NumArgs = 2; 11893 } 11894 11895 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs); 11896 11897 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 11898 if (Fns.empty()) 11899 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy, 11900 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc); 11901 11902 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 11903 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 11904 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 11905 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 11906 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 11907 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 11908 return new (Context) 11909 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, Context.DependentTy, 11910 VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPOptions()); 11911 } 11912 11913 // Build an empty overload set. 11914 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 11915 11916 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 11917 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 11918 11919 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 11920 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 11921 11922 // Add candidates from ADL. 11923 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray, 11924 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr, 11925 CandidateSet); 11926 11927 // Add builtin operator candidates. 11928 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 11929 11930 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 11931 11932 // Perform overload resolution. 11933 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11934 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 11935 case OR_Success: { 11936 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 11937 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 11938 11939 if (FnDecl) { 11940 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 11941 // operator. 11942 11943 // Convert the arguments. 11944 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 11945 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 11946 11947 ExprResult InputRes = 11948 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 11949 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 11950 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 11951 return ExprError(); 11952 Input = InputRes.get(); 11953 } else { 11954 // Convert the arguments. 11955 ExprResult InputInit 11956 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 11957 Context, 11958 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 11959 SourceLocation(), 11960 Input); 11961 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 11962 return ExprError(); 11963 Input = InputInit.get(); 11964 } 11965 11966 // Build the actual expression node. 11967 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl, 11968 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 11969 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 11970 return ExprError(); 11971 11972 // Determine the result type. 11973 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 11974 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 11975 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 11976 11977 Args[0] = Input; 11978 CallExpr *TheCall = 11979 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, 11980 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, FPOptions()); 11981 11982 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 11983 return ExprError(); 11984 11985 if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall, 11986 FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 11987 return ExprError(); 11988 11989 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 11990 } else { 11991 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 11992 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 11993 // operator node. 11994 ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion( 11995 Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 11996 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 11997 return ExprError(); 11998 Input = InputRes.get(); 11999 break; 12000 } 12001 } 12002 12003 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 12004 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 12005 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 12006 // defined too late to be candidates. 12007 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray)) 12008 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 12009 return ExprError(); 12010 12011 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 12012 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 12013 break; 12014 12015 case OR_Ambiguous: 12016 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 12017 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12018 << Input->getType() 12019 << Input->getSourceRange(); 12020 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray, 12021 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12022 return ExprError(); 12023 12024 case OR_Deleted: 12025 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 12026 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 12027 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12028 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12029 << Input->getSourceRange(); 12030 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, 12031 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12032 return ExprError(); 12033 } 12034 12035 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 12036 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 12037 // build a built-in operation. 12038 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 12039 } 12040 12041 /// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 12042 /// operator. 12043 /// 12044 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 12045 /// 12046 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 12047 /// 12048 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 12049 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 12050 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 12051 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 12052 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 12053 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 12054 /// 12055 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 12056 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 12057 ExprResult 12058 Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 12059 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12060 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 12061 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 12062 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 12063 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 12064 12065 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 12066 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12067 12068 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 12069 // expression. 12070 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 12071 if (Fns.empty()) { 12072 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 12073 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 12074 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign) 12075 return new (Context) BinaryOperator( 12076 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 12077 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12078 12079 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 12080 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, 12081 Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc, 12082 FPFeatures); 12083 } 12084 12085 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 12086 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 12087 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 12088 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 12089 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 12090 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 12091 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 12092 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 12093 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 12094 return new (Context) 12095 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, 12096 VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12097 } 12098 12099 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 12100 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 12101 return ExprError(); 12102 12103 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 12104 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 12105 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 12106 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 12107 return ExprError(); 12108 12109 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 12110 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 12111 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 12112 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 12113 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 12114 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 12115 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 12116 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 12117 12118 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 12119 // create a built-in binary operator. 12120 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 12121 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 12122 12123 // Build an empty overload set. 12124 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 12125 12126 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 12127 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet); 12128 12129 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 12130 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 12131 12132 // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not 12133 // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->, 12134 // which don't get here). 12135 if (Opc != BO_Assign) 12136 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args, 12137 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 12138 CandidateSet); 12139 12140 // Add builtin operator candidates. 12141 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 12142 12143 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12144 12145 // Perform overload resolution. 12146 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12147 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 12148 case OR_Success: { 12149 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 12150 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 12151 12152 if (FnDecl) { 12153 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 12154 // operator. 12155 12156 // Convert the arguments. 12157 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 12158 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 12159 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 12160 12161 ExprResult Arg1 = 12162 PerformCopyInitialization( 12163 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 12164 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 12165 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 12166 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 12167 return ExprError(); 12168 12169 ExprResult Arg0 = 12170 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 12171 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 12172 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 12173 return ExprError(); 12174 Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 12175 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 12176 } else { 12177 // Convert the arguments. 12178 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 12179 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 12180 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 12181 SourceLocation(), Args[0]); 12182 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 12183 return ExprError(); 12184 12185 ExprResult Arg1 = 12186 PerformCopyInitialization( 12187 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 12188 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 12189 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 12190 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 12191 return ExprError(); 12192 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 12193 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 12194 } 12195 12196 // Build the actual expression node. 12197 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 12198 Best->FoundDecl, 12199 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 12200 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 12201 return ExprError(); 12202 12203 // Determine the result type. 12204 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 12205 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12206 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12207 12208 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 12209 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), 12210 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 12211 FPFeatures); 12212 12213 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 12214 FnDecl)) 12215 return ExprError(); 12216 12217 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2); 12218 const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr; 12219 // Cut off the implicit 'this'. 12220 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 12221 ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0]; 12222 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1); 12223 } 12224 12225 // Check for a self move. 12226 if (Op == OO_Equal) 12227 DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc); 12228 12229 checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray, 12230 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(), 12231 VariadicDoesNotApply); 12232 12233 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12234 } else { 12235 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 12236 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 12237 // operator node. 12238 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 12239 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], 12240 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 12241 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 12242 return ExprError(); 12243 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 12244 12245 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 12246 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], 12247 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 12248 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 12249 return ExprError(); 12250 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 12251 break; 12252 } 12253 } 12254 12255 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 12256 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 12257 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 12258 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 12259 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 12260 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 12261 break; 12262 12263 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment 12264 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 12265 // no overloaded assignment operator found 12266 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 12267 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 12268 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 12269 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 12270 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12271 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12272 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) { 12273 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete) 12274 << Args[0]->getType() 12275 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12276 } 12277 } else { 12278 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 12279 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 12280 // defined too late to be candidates. 12281 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 12282 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 12283 return ExprError(); 12284 12285 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 12286 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 12287 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 12288 } 12289 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 12290 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 12291 if (Result.isInvalid()) 12292 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 12293 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12294 return Result; 12295 } 12296 12297 case OR_Ambiguous: 12298 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 12299 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12300 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 12301 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12302 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 12303 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12304 return ExprError(); 12305 12306 case OR_Deleted: 12307 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 12308 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 12309 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 12310 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent()) 12311 << getSpecialMember(Method); 12312 12313 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 12314 // explain why it's deleted. 12315 NoteDeletedFunction(Method); 12316 return ExprError(); 12317 } else { 12318 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 12319 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 12320 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12321 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12322 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12323 } 12324 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 12325 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12326 return ExprError(); 12327 } 12328 12329 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 12330 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 12331 } 12332 12333 ExprResult 12334 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 12335 SourceLocation RLoc, 12336 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 12337 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 12338 DeclarationName OpName = 12339 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 12340 12341 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 12342 // expression. 12343 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 12344 12345 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 12346 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 12347 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 12348 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 12349 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 12350 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 12351 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 12352 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false, 12353 UnresolvedSetIterator(), 12354 UnresolvedSetIterator()); 12355 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 12356 12357 return new (Context) 12358 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args, 12359 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, FPOptions()); 12360 } 12361 12362 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 12363 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 12364 return ExprError(); 12365 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 12366 return ExprError(); 12367 12368 // Build an empty overload set. 12369 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 12370 12371 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 12372 12373 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 12374 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 12375 12376 // Add builtin operator candidates. 12377 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 12378 12379 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12380 12381 // Perform overload resolution. 12382 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12383 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 12384 case OR_Success: { 12385 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 12386 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 12387 12388 if (FnDecl) { 12389 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 12390 // operator. 12391 12392 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 12393 12394 // Convert the arguments. 12395 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 12396 ExprResult Arg0 = 12397 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 12398 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 12399 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 12400 return ExprError(); 12401 Args[0] = Arg0.get(); 12402 12403 // Convert the arguments. 12404 ExprResult InputInit 12405 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 12406 Context, 12407 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 12408 SourceLocation(), 12409 Args[1]); 12410 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 12411 return ExprError(); 12412 12413 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 12414 12415 // Build the actual expression node. 12416 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 12417 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 12418 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 12419 Best->FoundDecl, 12420 HadMultipleCandidates, 12421 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 12422 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 12423 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 12424 return ExprError(); 12425 12426 // Determine the result type 12427 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 12428 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12429 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12430 12431 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 12432 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, 12433 FnExpr.get(), Args, 12434 ResultTy, VK, RLoc, 12435 FPOptions()); 12436 12437 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 12438 return ExprError(); 12439 12440 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 12441 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 12442 return ExprError(); 12443 12444 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12445 } else { 12446 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 12447 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 12448 // operator node. 12449 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 12450 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], 12451 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 12452 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 12453 return ExprError(); 12454 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 12455 12456 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 12457 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], 12458 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 12459 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 12460 return ExprError(); 12461 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 12462 12463 break; 12464 } 12465 } 12466 12467 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 12468 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 12469 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 12470 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 12471 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12472 else 12473 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 12474 << Args[0]->getType() 12475 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12476 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 12477 "[]", LLoc); 12478 return ExprError(); 12479 } 12480 12481 case OR_Ambiguous: 12482 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 12483 << "[]" 12484 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 12485 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12486 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 12487 "[]", LLoc); 12488 return ExprError(); 12489 12490 case OR_Deleted: 12491 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 12492 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]" 12493 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12494 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12495 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 12496 "[]", LLoc); 12497 return ExprError(); 12498 } 12499 12500 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 12501 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 12502 } 12503 12504 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 12505 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 12506 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 12507 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 12508 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 12509 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 12510 /// member function. 12511 ExprResult 12512 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 12513 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12514 MultiExprArg Args, 12515 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 12516 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 12517 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12518 12519 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 12520 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 12521 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 12522 12523 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 12524 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 12525 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 12526 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 12527 12528 QualType fnType = 12529 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 12530 12531 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 12532 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 12533 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType()); 12534 12535 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 12536 // member function we're calling. 12537 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals()); 12538 12539 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 12540 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 12541 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 12542 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 12543 12544 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 12545 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 12546 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 12547 if (difference) { 12548 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 12549 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 12550 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 12551 << qualsString 12552 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 12553 } 12554 12555 CXXMemberCallExpr *call 12556 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, 12557 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc); 12558 12559 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getLocStart(), 12560 call, nullptr)) 12561 return ExprError(); 12562 12563 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc)) 12564 return ExprError(); 12565 12566 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto)) 12567 return ExprError(); 12568 12569 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 12570 } 12571 12572 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) 12573 return new (Context) 12574 CallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 12575 12576 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12577 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 12578 return ExprError(); 12579 12580 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 12581 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr; 12582 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public); 12583 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr; 12584 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 12585 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 12586 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 12587 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 12588 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 12589 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12590 } else { 12591 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 12592 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 12593 12594 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 12595 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 12596 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 12597 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 12598 12599 // Add overload candidates 12600 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 12601 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 12602 12603 // FIXME: avoid copy. 12604 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 12605 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12606 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 12607 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 12608 } 12609 12610 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 12611 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12612 12613 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 12614 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 12615 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 12616 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 12617 12618 12619 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 12620 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 12621 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), 12622 Args, CandidateSet); 12623 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 12624 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 12625 // non-template member function. 12626 if (TemplateArgs) 12627 continue; 12628 12629 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 12630 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 12631 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 12632 } else { 12633 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 12634 cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC, 12635 TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 12636 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false); 12637 } 12638 } 12639 12640 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 12641 12642 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12643 12644 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12645 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(), 12646 Best)) { 12647 case OR_Success: 12648 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 12649 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 12650 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 12651 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 12652 return ExprError(); 12653 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template 12654 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 12655 // called on both. 12656 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 12657 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 12658 // being used. 12659 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() && 12660 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 12661 return ExprError(); 12662 break; 12663 12664 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 12665 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 12666 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 12667 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 12668 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12669 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 12670 return ExprError(); 12671 12672 case OR_Ambiguous: 12673 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 12674 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 12675 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12676 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 12677 return ExprError(); 12678 12679 case OR_Deleted: 12680 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 12681 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 12682 << DeclName 12683 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12684 << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 12685 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12686 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 12687 return ExprError(); 12688 } 12689 12690 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 12691 12692 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 12693 // non-member call based on that function. 12694 if (Method->isStatic()) { 12695 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args, 12696 RParenLoc); 12697 } 12698 12699 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 12700 } 12701 12702 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType(); 12703 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 12704 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12705 12706 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 12707 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = 12708 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, 12709 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc); 12710 12711 // Check for a valid return type. 12712 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 12713 TheCall, Method)) 12714 return ExprError(); 12715 12716 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 12717 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 12718 // it was done at lookup. 12719 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 12720 ExprResult ObjectArg = 12721 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 12722 FoundDecl, Method); 12723 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 12724 return ExprError(); 12725 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get()); 12726 } 12727 12728 // Convert the rest of the arguments 12729 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 12730 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 12731 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, 12732 RParenLoc)) 12733 return ExprError(); 12734 12735 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 12736 12737 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 12738 return ExprError(); 12739 12740 // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading 12741 // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do 12742 // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors. 12743 if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 12744 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) { 12745 Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(), 12746 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 12747 << Method << Method->getSourceRange(); 12748 Diag(Method->getLocation(), 12749 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 12750 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 12751 return ExprError(); 12752 } 12753 } 12754 12755 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 12756 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 12757 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 12758 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 12759 12760 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) && 12761 MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 12762 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(), 12763 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 12764 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 12765 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName(); 12766 12767 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 12768 if (getLangOpts().AppleKext) 12769 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(), 12770 diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext) 12771 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName() 12772 << MD->getDeclName(); 12773 } 12774 } 12775 12776 if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD = 12777 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) { 12778 // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode. 12779 bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext; 12780 CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getLocStart(), /*IsDelete=*/false, 12781 CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true, 12782 MemExpr->getMemberLoc()); 12783 } 12784 12785 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12786 } 12787 12788 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 12789 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 12790 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 12791 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 12792 ExprResult 12793 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 12794 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12795 MultiExprArg Args, 12796 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 12797 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 12798 return ExprError(); 12799 ExprResult Object = Obj; 12800 12801 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12802 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 12803 return ExprError(); 12804 12805 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && 12806 "Requires object type argument"); 12807 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 12808 12809 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 12810 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 12811 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 12812 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 12813 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 12814 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 12815 // (E).operator(). 12816 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc, 12817 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 12818 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 12819 12820 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 12821 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 12822 return true; 12823 12824 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 12825 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 12826 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12827 12828 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 12829 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 12830 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 12831 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet, 12832 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 12833 } 12834 12835 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 12836 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 12837 // declared in T of the form 12838 // 12839 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 12840 // 12841 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 12842 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 12843 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 12844 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 12845 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 12846 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 12847 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 12848 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 12849 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 12850 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 12851 // within T by another intervening declaration. 12852 const auto &Conversions = 12853 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 12854 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 12855 NamedDecl *D = *I; 12856 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 12857 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 12858 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 12859 12860 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 12861 // surrogates. 12862 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 12863 continue; 12864 12865 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 12866 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 12867 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 12868 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 12869 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 12870 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 12871 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 12872 12873 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 12874 { 12875 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 12876 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet); 12877 } 12878 } 12879 } 12880 12881 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12882 12883 // Perform overload resolution. 12884 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12885 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(), 12886 Best)) { 12887 case OR_Success: 12888 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 12889 // below. 12890 break; 12891 12892 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 12893 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 12894 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 12895 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 12896 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 12897 else 12898 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 12899 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 12900 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 12901 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12902 break; 12903 12904 case OR_Ambiguous: 12905 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 12906 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 12907 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 12908 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 12909 break; 12910 12911 case OR_Deleted: 12912 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 12913 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 12914 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 12915 << Object.get()->getType() 12916 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12917 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 12918 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12919 break; 12920 } 12921 12922 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 12923 return true; 12924 12925 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12926 12927 if (Best->Function == nullptr) { 12928 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 12929 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 12930 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 12931 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 12932 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 12933 12934 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, 12935 Best->FoundDecl); 12936 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc)) 12937 return ExprError(); 12938 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() && 12939 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!"); 12940 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 12941 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 12942 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job. 12943 12944 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 12945 // and then call it. 12946 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 12947 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 12948 if (Call.isInvalid()) 12949 return ExprError(); 12950 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 12951 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(), 12952 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(), 12953 nullptr, VK_RValue); 12954 12955 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc); 12956 } 12957 12958 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 12959 12960 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 12961 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 12962 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 12963 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 12964 12965 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration. 12966 if (Method->isInvalidDecl()) 12967 return ExprError(); 12968 12969 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 12970 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 12971 12972 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 12973 12974 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 12975 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 12976 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 12977 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 12978 HadMultipleCandidates, 12979 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 12980 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 12981 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 12982 return true; 12983 12984 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object 12985 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list). 12986 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(Args.size() + 1); 12987 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 12988 std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), MethodArgs.begin() + 1); 12989 12990 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly 12991 // owned. 12992 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 12993 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12994 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12995 12996 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) 12997 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, 12998 VK, RParenLoc, FPOptions()); 12999 13000 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method)) 13001 return true; 13002 13003 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more 13004 // slots in the call for them. 13005 if (Args.size() < NumParams) 13006 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams + 1); 13007 13008 bool IsError = false; 13009 13010 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 13011 ExprResult ObjRes = 13012 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13013 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13014 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 13015 IsError = true; 13016 else 13017 Object = ObjRes; 13018 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.get()); 13019 13020 // Check the argument types. 13021 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) { 13022 Expr *Arg; 13023 if (i < Args.size()) { 13024 Arg = Args[i]; 13025 13026 // Pass the argument. 13027 13028 ExprResult InputInit 13029 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13030 Context, 13031 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 13032 SourceLocation(), Arg); 13033 13034 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 13035 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 13036 } else { 13037 ExprResult DefArg 13038 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 13039 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 13040 IsError = true; 13041 break; 13042 } 13043 13044 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>(); 13045 } 13046 13047 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg); 13048 } 13049 13050 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 13051 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 13052 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 13053 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) { 13054 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 13055 nullptr); 13056 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 13057 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.get()); 13058 } 13059 } 13060 13061 if (IsError) return true; 13062 13063 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 13064 13065 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 13066 return true; 13067 13068 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13069 } 13070 13071 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 13072 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 13073 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 13074 ExprResult 13075 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, 13076 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) { 13077 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 13078 "left-hand side must have class type"); 13079 13080 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 13081 return ExprError(); 13082 13083 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 13084 13085 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 13086 // 13087 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 13088 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 13089 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 13090 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 13091 DeclarationName OpName = 13092 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 13093 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13094 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 13095 13096 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 13097 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 13098 return ExprError(); 13099 13100 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 13101 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl()); 13102 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 13103 13104 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 13105 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 13106 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 13107 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 13108 } 13109 13110 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13111 13112 // Perform overload resolution. 13113 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13114 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13115 case OR_Success: 13116 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 13117 break; 13118 13119 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13120 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 13121 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 13122 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) { 13123 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a 13124 // diagnostic, as requested. 13125 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true; 13126 return ExprError(); 13127 } 13128 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 13129 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange(); 13130 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) { 13131 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion) 13132 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "."); 13133 } 13134 } else 13135 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 13136 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 13137 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 13138 return ExprError(); 13139 13140 case OR_Ambiguous: 13141 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 13142 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 13143 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base); 13144 return ExprError(); 13145 13146 case OR_Deleted: 13147 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13148 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 13149 << "->" 13150 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 13151 << Base->getSourceRange(); 13152 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 13153 return ExprError(); 13154 } 13155 13156 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 13157 13158 // Convert the object parameter. 13159 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 13160 ExprResult BaseResult = 13161 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13162 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13163 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 13164 return ExprError(); 13165 Base = BaseResult.get(); 13166 13167 // Build the operator call. 13168 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 13169 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 13170 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13171 return ExprError(); 13172 13173 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 13174 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13175 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13176 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 13177 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), 13178 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, FPOptions()); 13179 13180 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method)) 13181 return ExprError(); 13182 13183 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 13184 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13185 return ExprError(); 13186 13187 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13188 } 13189 13190 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 13191 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 13192 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 13193 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 13194 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 13195 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 13196 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 13197 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 13198 13199 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc, 13200 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 13201 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, TemplateArgs, 13202 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true); 13203 13204 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13205 13206 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 13207 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 13208 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13209 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 13210 case OR_Success: 13211 case OR_Deleted: 13212 break; 13213 13214 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13215 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 13216 << R.getLookupName(); 13217 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13218 return ExprError(); 13219 13220 case OR_Ambiguous: 13221 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName(); 13222 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 13223 return ExprError(); 13224 } 13225 13226 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 13227 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl, 13228 HadMultipleCandidates, 13229 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 13230 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 13231 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13232 return true; 13233 13234 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 13235 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 13236 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 13237 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 13238 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 13239 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 13240 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 13241 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13242 return true; 13243 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get(); 13244 } 13245 13246 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType(); 13247 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13248 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13249 13250 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = 13251 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.get(), 13252 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), 13253 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc); 13254 13255 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 13256 return ExprError(); 13257 13258 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr)) 13259 return ExprError(); 13260 13261 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL); 13262 } 13263 13264 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the 13265 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which 13266 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument 13267 /// dependent lookup. 13268 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success, 13269 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value 13270 /// is returned. 13271 Sema::ForRangeStatus 13272 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc, 13273 SourceLocation RangeLoc, 13274 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 13275 LookupResult &MemberLookup, 13276 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 13277 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) { 13278 Scope *S = nullptr; 13279 13280 CandidateSet->clear(); 13281 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) { 13282 ExprResult MemberRef = 13283 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc, 13284 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(), 13285 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 13286 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, 13287 MemberLookup, 13288 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 13289 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) { 13290 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13291 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 13292 } 13293 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr); 13294 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) { 13295 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13296 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 13297 } 13298 } else { 13299 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames; 13300 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = 13301 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr, 13302 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo, 13303 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false, 13304 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end()); 13305 13306 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc, 13307 CandidateSet, CallExpr); 13308 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) { 13309 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13310 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 13311 } 13312 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13313 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 13314 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best); 13315 13316 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) { 13317 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13318 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 13319 } 13320 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range, 13321 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best, 13322 OverloadResult, 13323 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false); 13324 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) { 13325 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13326 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 13327 } 13328 } 13329 return FRS_Success; 13330 } 13331 13332 13333 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 13334 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 13335 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 13336 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 13337 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 13338 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 13339 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 13340 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 13341 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 13342 Found, Fn); 13343 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 13344 return PE; 13345 13346 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 13347 } 13348 13349 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 13350 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 13351 Found, Fn); 13352 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 13353 SubExpr->getType()) && 13354 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 13355 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 13356 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 13357 return ICE; 13358 13359 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), 13360 ICE->getCastKind(), 13361 SubExpr, nullptr, 13362 ICE->getValueKind()); 13363 } 13364 13365 if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) { 13366 if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) { 13367 Expr *SubExpr = 13368 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn); 13369 if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr()) 13370 return GSE; 13371 13372 // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic 13373 // selection expression. 13374 ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs(); 13375 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end()); 13376 unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex(); 13377 AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr; 13378 13379 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 13380 Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 13381 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 13382 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(), 13383 ResultIdx); 13384 } 13385 // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic 13386 // selection expression. 13387 return GSE; 13388 } 13389 13390 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 13391 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 13392 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 13393 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 13394 if (Method->isStatic()) { 13395 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 13396 // from non-member functions. 13397 } else { 13398 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an 13399 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 13400 // or template. 13401 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 13402 Found, Fn); 13403 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 13404 return UnOp; 13405 13406 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 13407 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 13408 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 13409 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 13410 13411 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 13412 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 13413 // appropriate pointer to member type. 13414 QualType ClassType 13415 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 13416 QualType MemPtrType 13417 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 13418 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 13419 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 13420 (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType); 13421 13422 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, 13423 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 13424 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 13425 } 13426 } 13427 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 13428 Found, Fn); 13429 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 13430 return UnOp; 13431 13432 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 13433 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 13434 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 13435 UnOp->getOperatorLoc()); 13436 } 13437 13438 // C++ [except.spec]p17: 13439 // An exception-specification is considered to be needed when: 13440 // - in an expression the function is the unique lookup result or the 13441 // selected member of a set of overloaded functions 13442 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 13443 ResolveExceptionSpec(E->getExprLoc(), FPT); 13444 13445 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 13446 // FIXME: avoid copy. 13447 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 13448 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 13449 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 13450 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 13451 } 13452 13453 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 13454 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), 13455 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 13456 Fn, 13457 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME? 13458 ULE->getNameLoc(), 13459 Fn->getType(), 13460 VK_LValue, 13461 Found.getDecl(), 13462 TemplateArgs); 13463 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 13464 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 13465 return DRE; 13466 } 13467 13468 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 13469 // FIXME: avoid copy. 13470 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 13471 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 13472 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 13473 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 13474 } 13475 13476 Expr *Base; 13477 13478 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 13479 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 13480 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 13481 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 13482 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 13483 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), 13484 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 13485 Fn, 13486 /*enclosing*/ false, 13487 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 13488 Fn->getType(), 13489 VK_LValue, 13490 Found.getDecl(), 13491 TemplateArgs); 13492 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 13493 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 13494 return DRE; 13495 } else { 13496 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 13497 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 13498 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 13499 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc); 13500 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, 13501 MemExpr->getBaseType(), 13502 /*isImplicit=*/true); 13503 } 13504 } else 13505 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 13506 13507 ExprValueKind valueKind; 13508 QualType type; 13509 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 13510 valueKind = VK_LValue; 13511 type = Fn->getType(); 13512 } else { 13513 valueKind = VK_RValue; 13514 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 13515 } 13516 13517 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create( 13518 Context, Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(), 13519 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found, 13520 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), TemplateArgs, type, valueKind, 13521 OK_Ordinary); 13522 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 13523 MarkMemberReferenced(ME); 13524 return ME; 13525 } 13526 13527 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 13528 } 13529 13530 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 13531 DeclAccessPair Found, 13532 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 13533 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn); 13534 } 13535